blob: dd781a86031ef26c62f904d1fdb377430f941e14 [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregore9d62932011-07-15 16:25:15 +000041 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
42 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000043 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(),
44 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
45 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
46 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
47 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000048 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
49 if (E.isInvalid())
50 return ExprError();
51 return move(E);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000052}
53
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000054static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
55 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000056 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +000057 bool CStyle,
58 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000059
60static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
61 QualType &ToType,
62 bool InOverloadResolution,
63 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
64 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000065static OverloadingResult
66IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
67 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
68 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
69 bool AllowExplicit);
70
71
72static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
73CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
74 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
75 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
76
77static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
78CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
79 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
80 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
81
82static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
83CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
84 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
85 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
86
87
88
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000089/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
90/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000091ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000092GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
93 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
94 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
95 ICC_Identity,
96 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
97 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
98 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000099 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
101 ICC_Promotion,
102 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000103 ICC_Promotion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
105 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000106 ICC_Conversion,
107 ICC_Conversion,
108 ICC_Conversion,
109 ICC_Conversion,
110 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000111 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000113 ICC_Conversion,
114 ICC_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000115 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000116 ICC_Conversion
117 };
118 return Category[(int)Kind];
119}
120
121/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
122/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
123ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
124 static const ImplicitConversionRank
125 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
126 ICR_Exact_Match,
127 ICR_Exact_Match,
128 ICR_Exact_Match,
129 ICR_Exact_Match,
130 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000131 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000132 ICR_Promotion,
133 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000134 ICR_Promotion,
135 ICR_Conversion,
136 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
139 ICR_Conversion,
140 ICR_Conversion,
141 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000142 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000143 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000144 ICR_Conversion,
145 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000146 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
147 ICR_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000148 ICR_Conversion,
149 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 };
151 return Rank[(int)Kind];
152}
153
154/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
155/// implicit conversion.
156const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000157 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000158 "No conversion",
159 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
160 "Array-to-pointer",
161 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000162 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000163 "Qualification",
164 "Integral promotion",
165 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000166 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000167 "Integral conversion",
168 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000169 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000170 "Floating-integral conversion",
171 "Pointer conversion",
172 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000173 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000174 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000175 "Derived-to-base conversion",
176 "Vector conversion",
177 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000178 "Complex-real conversion",
179 "Block Pointer conversion",
180 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000181 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000182 };
183 return Name[Kind];
184}
185
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000186/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
187/// sequence to the identity conversion.
188void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
189 First = ICK_Identity;
190 Second = ICK_Identity;
191 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000192 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000193 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000194 ReferenceBinding = false;
195 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000196 IsLvalueReference = true;
197 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
198 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000199 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000200 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000201 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000202}
203
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000204/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
205/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
206/// implicit conversions.
207ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
208 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
209 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
210 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
211 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
212 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
213 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
214 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
215 return Rank;
216}
217
218/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
219/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000220/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000222bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000223 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
224 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
225 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
226 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000227 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000228 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
229 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
230 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000231 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000232 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
233 return true;
234
235 return false;
236}
237
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000238/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
239/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
240/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
241/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000242bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000243StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000244isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000245 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000246 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000247
248 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
249 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
250 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
251 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
252 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
253
Douglas Gregor5d3d3fa2011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000254 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000255 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000256 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
257
258 return false;
259}
260
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000261/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
262/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
263static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
264 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
265 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
266 case CK_NoOp:
267 case CK_IntegralCast:
268 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
269 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
270 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
271 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
272 case CK_FloatingCast:
273 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
274 continue;
275
276 default:
277 return Converted;
278 }
279 }
280
281 return Converted;
282}
283
284/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
285/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
286///
287/// \param Ctx The AST context.
288/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
289/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
290/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
291NarrowingKind
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000292StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
293 const Expr *Converted,
294 APValue &ConstantValue) const {
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000295 assert(Ctx.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
296
297 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
298 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
299 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
300 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
301 switch (Second) {
302 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
303 //
304 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
305 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
306 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
307 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
308 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
309 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
310 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
311 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
312 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
313 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
314 if (Initializer &&
315 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
316 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
317 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
318 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
319 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
320 // And back.
321 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
322 bool ignored;
323 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
324 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
325 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
326 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
327 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
328 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
329 }
330 } else {
331 // Variables are always narrowings.
332 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
333 }
334 }
335 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
336
337 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
338 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
339 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
340 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
341 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
342 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
343 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
344 // FromType is larger than ToType.
345 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
346 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
347 // Constant!
348 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
349 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
350 // Convert the source value into the target type.
351 bool ignored;
352 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
353 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
354 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
355 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
356 // values that can be represented.
357 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow)
358 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
359 } else {
360 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
361 }
362 }
363 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
364
365 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
366 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
367 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
368 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
369 // value when converted back to the original type.
370 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
371 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
372 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
373 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
374 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
375 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
376 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
377 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
378 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
379 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
380 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
381 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
382 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
383
384 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
385 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned)) {
386 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
387 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
388 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
389 if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
390 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
391
392 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
393 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
394 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
395 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
396 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
397 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
398 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
399 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
400 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
401 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
402 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
403 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
404 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
405 } else {
406 // Variables are always narrowings.
407 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
408 }
409 }
410 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
411 }
412
413 default:
414 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
415 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
416 }
417}
418
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000419/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
420/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
421void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000422 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000423 bool PrintedSomething = false;
424 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000425 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000426 PrintedSomething = true;
427 }
428
429 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
430 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000431 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000432 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000433 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000434
435 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000436 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000437 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000438 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000439 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000440 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000441 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000442 PrintedSomething = true;
443 }
444
445 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
446 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000447 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000448 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000449 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000450 PrintedSomething = true;
451 }
452
453 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000454 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455 }
456}
457
458/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
459/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
460void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000461 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000462 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
463 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000464 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000465 }
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000466 if (ConversionFunction)
467 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
468 else
469 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000470 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000471 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000472 After.DebugPrint();
473 }
474}
475
476/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
477/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
478void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000479 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000480 switch (ConversionKind) {
481 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000482 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000483 Standard.DebugPrint();
484 break;
485 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000486 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000487 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
488 break;
489 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000490 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000491 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000492 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000493 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000494 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000495 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000496 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000497 break;
498 }
499
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000500 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000501}
502
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000503void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
504 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
505}
506
507void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
508 conversions().~ConversionSet();
509}
510
511void
512AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
513 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
514 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
515 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
516}
517
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000518namespace {
519 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
520 // template parameter and template argument information.
521 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
522 TemplateParameter Param;
523 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
524 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
525 };
526}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000527
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000528/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
529/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
530OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000531static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
532 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000533 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000534 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
535 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
536 Result.Data = 0;
537 switch (TDK) {
538 case Sema::TDK_Success:
539 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000540 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
541 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000542 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000543
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000544 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000545 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000546 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
547 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000548
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000549 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000550 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000551 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
552 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000553 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
554 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
555 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
556 Result.Data = Saved;
557 break;
558 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000559
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000560 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000561 Result.Data = Info.take();
562 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000563
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000564 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000565 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000566 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000567 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000568
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000569 return Result;
570}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000571
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000572void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
573 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
574 case Sema::TDK_Success:
575 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
576 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000577 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
578 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000579 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000580 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000581
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000582 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000583 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000584 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000585 Data = 0;
586 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000587
588 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
589 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
590 Data = 0;
591 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000592
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000593 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000594 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000595 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
596 break;
597 }
598}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000599
600TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000601OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
602 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
603 case Sema::TDK_Success:
604 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000605 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
606 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000607 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000608 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000609
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000610 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000611 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000612 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000613
614 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000615 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000616 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000617
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000618 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000619 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000620 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
621 break;
622 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000623
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000624 return TemplateParameter();
625}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000626
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000627TemplateArgumentList *
628OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
629 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
630 case Sema::TDK_Success:
631 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
632 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
633 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
634 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
635 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
636 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000637 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000638 return 0;
639
640 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
641 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000642
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000643 // Unhandled
644 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
645 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
646 break;
647 }
648
649 return 0;
650}
651
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000652const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
653 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
654 case Sema::TDK_Success:
655 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
656 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000657 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
658 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000659 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000660 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000661 return 0;
662
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000663 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000664 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000665 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000666
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000667 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000668 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000669 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
670 break;
671 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000672
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000674}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000675
676const TemplateArgument *
677OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
678 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
679 case Sema::TDK_Success:
680 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
681 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000682 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
683 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000684 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000685 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000686 return 0;
687
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000688 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000689 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000690 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
691
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000692 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000693 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000694 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
695 break;
696 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000697
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000698 return 0;
699}
700
701void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Benjamin Kramer02b08432012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000702 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i)
703 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
704 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Benjamin Kramer0b9c5092012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000705 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000706 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000707 Functions.clear();
708}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000709
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000710namespace {
711 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
712 struct Entry {
713 Expr **Addr;
714 Expr *Saved;
715 };
716 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
717
718 public:
719 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
720 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
721 Entry entry = { &E, E };
722 Entries.push_back(entry);
723 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
724 }
725
726 void restore() {
727 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
728 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
729 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
730 }
731 };
732}
733
734/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
735/// preprocessing on the given expression.
736///
737/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
738/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
739///
740/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
741static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
742 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000743 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
744 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
745 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
746 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
747
748 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
749 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
750 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
751 unbridgedCasts) {
752 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
753 return false;
754 }
755
756 // Go ahead and check everything else.
757 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
758 if (result.isInvalid())
759 return true;
760
761 E = result.take();
762 return false;
763 }
764
765 // Nothing to do.
766 return false;
767}
768
769/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
770/// placeholders.
771static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
772 unsigned numArgs,
773 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
774 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
775 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
776 return true;
777
778 return false;
779}
780
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000781// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000782// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
783// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
784// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
785// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000786// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
787// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
788// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000789//
790// Example: Given the following input:
791//
792// void f(int, float); // #1
793// void f(int, int); // #2
794// int f(int, int); // #3
795//
796// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000797// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000798//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000799// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
800// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
801// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
802// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000803//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000804// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
805// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
806// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
807// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000808// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
809// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000810//
811// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
812// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
813// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
814// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000815Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000816Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
817 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000818 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000819 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000820 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
821
822 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
823 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
824 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
825
826 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
827 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
828 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
829
830 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
831 }
832
833 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
834 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
835 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
836 // function templates hide function templates with different
837 // return types or template parameter lists.
838 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
839 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
840
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000841 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000842 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
843 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
844 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
845 continue;
846 }
847
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000848 Match = *I;
849 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000850 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000851 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000852 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
853 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
854 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
855 continue;
856 }
857
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000858 Match = *I;
859 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000860 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000861 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000862 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
863 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
864 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000865 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
866 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000867 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
868 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
869 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
870 // template instantiation.
871 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000872 // (C++ 13p1):
873 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
874 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000875 Match = *I;
876 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000877 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000878 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000879
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000880 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000881}
882
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000883bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
884 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000885 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
886 // overloads.
887 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
888 return false;
889
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000890 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
891 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
892
893 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
894 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
895 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
896 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
897 return true;
898
899 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
900 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
901 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
902
903 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
904 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
905 // in the signature, they are overloads.
906
907 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
908 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
909 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
910 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
911 return false;
912
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000913 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
914 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000915
916 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
917 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
918 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
919 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
920 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
921 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000922 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000923 return true;
924
925 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
926 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
927 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
928 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
929 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
930 // signature.
931 //
932 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
933 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000934 //
935 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
936 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
937 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000938 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
939 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
940 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
941 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
942 return true;
943
944 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000945 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000946 //
947 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
948 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
949 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
950 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
951 // can be overloaded.
952 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
953 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
954 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
955 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000956 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000957 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
958 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
959 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
960 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
961 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
962 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000963 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
964 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
965 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
966 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000967 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
968 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
969 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
970 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
971 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000972
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000973 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000974 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000975
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000976 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
977 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000978}
979
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +0000980/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
981/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
982///
983/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
984/// an available function, false otherwise.
985bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
986 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
987}
988
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +0000989/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
990///
991/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
992/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
993static ImplicitConversionSequence
994TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
995 bool SuppressUserConversions,
996 bool AllowExplicit,
997 bool InOverloadResolution,
998 bool CStyle,
999 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1000 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1001
1002 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1003 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1004 // we can perform.
1005 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1006 return ICS;
1007 }
1008
1009 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1010 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1011 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1012 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1013 AllowExplicit);
1014
1015 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1016 ICS.setUserDefined();
1017 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1018 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1019 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1020 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1021 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1022 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1023 // called for those cases.
1024 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1025 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1026 QualType FromCanon
1027 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1028 QualType ToCanon
1029 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1030 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1031 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1032 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1033 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1034 ICS.setStandard();
1035 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1036 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1037 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1038 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1039 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1040 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1041 }
1042 }
1043
1044 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1045 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1046 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1047 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1048 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1049 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1050 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1051 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1052 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1053 }
1054 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1055 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1056 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1057 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1058 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1059 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1060 if (Cand->Viable)
1061 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1062 } else {
1063 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1064 }
1065
1066 return ICS;
1067}
1068
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001069/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1070/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1071/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1072/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001073///
1074/// void f(float f);
1075/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1076///
1077/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1078/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1079/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1080/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1081//
1082/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1083/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1084/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1085/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1086/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001087///
1088/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1089/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001090/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1091/// permitted.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001092///
1093/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1094/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1095/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001096static ImplicitConversionSequence
1097TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1098 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001099 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001100 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001101 bool CStyle,
1102 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001103 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001104 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001105 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001106 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001107 return ICS;
1108 }
1109
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001110 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001111 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001112 return ICS;
1113 }
1114
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001115 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1116 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1117 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1118 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1119 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1120 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1121 // called for those cases.
1122 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1123 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001124 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1125 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001126 ICS.setStandard();
1127 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1128 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1129 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001130
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001131 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1132 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1133 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1134 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1135 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001136
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001137 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001138 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001139 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001140
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001141 return ICS;
1142 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001143
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001144 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1145 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1146 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001147}
1148
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001149ImplicitConversionSequence
1150Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1151 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1152 bool AllowExplicit,
1153 bool InOverloadResolution,
1154 bool CStyle,
1155 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1156 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1157 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1158 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1159 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001160}
1161
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001162/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001163/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001164/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1165/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1166/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001167ExprResult
1168Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001169 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001170 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001171 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001172}
1173
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001174ExprResult
1175Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001176 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001177 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001178 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1179 return ExprError();
1180
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001181 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1182 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1183 = getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1184 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001185
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001186 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1187 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1188 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001189 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001190 /*CStyle=*/false,
1191 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001192 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1193}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001194
1195/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001196/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001197bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1198 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001199 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1200 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001201
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001202 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1203 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1204 // - a pointer
1205 // - a member pointer
1206 // - a block pointer
1207 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1208 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1209 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1210 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1211 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1212 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1213 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1214 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1215 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1216 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1217 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1218 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1219 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1220 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1221 } else {
1222 return false;
1223 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001224
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001225 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1226 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1227 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1228 return false;
1229 }
1230
1231 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1232 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1233 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1234
1235 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1236 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1237 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1238
1239 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001240 return true;
1241}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001242
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001243/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1244/// vector conversion.
1245///
1246/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1247/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001248static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1249 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001250 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1251 // conversion.
1252 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1253 return false;
1254
1255 // Identical types require no conversions.
1256 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1257 return false;
1258
1259 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1260 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1261 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1262 // identity conversion.
1263 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1264 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001265
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001266 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001267 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001268 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1269 return true;
1270 }
1271 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001272
1273 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1274 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1275 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1276 // same size
1277 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1278 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001279 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
1280 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001281 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1282 return true;
1283 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001284 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001285
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001286 return false;
1287}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001288
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001289/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1290/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1291/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1292/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1293/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1294/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1295/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1296/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001297static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1298 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001299 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001300 bool CStyle,
1301 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001302 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001303
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001304 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001305 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001306 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001307 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001308 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001309 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001310
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001311 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001312 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001313 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001314 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001315 return false;
1316
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001317 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001318 }
1319
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001320 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1321 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1322 // (C++ 4p1).
1323
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001324 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001325 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1326 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001327 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001328 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001329 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1330 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1331 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001332
1333 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1334 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1335 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1336 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1337 QualType resultTy;
1338 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001339 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001340 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1341 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1342 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1343 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001344 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001345
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001346 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1347 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1348 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1349 // expression.
1350 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1351 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1352 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1353 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1354 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1355 == UO_AddrOf &&
1356 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1357 const Type *ClassType
1358 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1359 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001360 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1361 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1362 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001363 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1364 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1365 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001366
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001367 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001368 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1369 FromType,
1370 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001371 } else {
1372 return false;
1373 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001374 }
John McCall154a2fd2011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001375 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1376 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1377 // be converted to a prvalue.
1378 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001379 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001380 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001381 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001382 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001383
1384 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1385 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001386 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1387 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001388 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001389 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1390 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001391 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001392
1393 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1394 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1395 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001396 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001397
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001398 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001399 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001400 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001401
1402 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1403 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1404 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1405 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001406 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1407 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001408 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001409 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001410 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001411 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001412 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001413 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001414 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001415
1416 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1417 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1418 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001419 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001420 } else {
1421 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001422 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001423 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001424 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001425
1426 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1427 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1428 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1429 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001430 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1431 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001432 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001433 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001434 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001435 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1436 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001437 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001438 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001439 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001440 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001441 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001442 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001443 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001444 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001445 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001446 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001447 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001448 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1449 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001450 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1451 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1452 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1453 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1454 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1455 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1456 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1457 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1458 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001459 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001460 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001461 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001462 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001463 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001464 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001465 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001466 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1467 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001468 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1469 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001470 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1471 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1472 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001473 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001474 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1475 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1476 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001477 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001478 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001479 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001480 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001481 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001482 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001483 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001484 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001485 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1486 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1487 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1488 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001489 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1490 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001491 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001492 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001493 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001494 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001495 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001496 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001497 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001498 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001499 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001500 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1501 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001502 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1503 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001504 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001505 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001506 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001507 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001508 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1509 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001510 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1511 InOverloadResolution,
1512 SCS, CStyle)) {
1513 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1514 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001515 } else {
1516 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001517 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001518 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001519 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001520
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001521 QualType CanonFrom;
1522 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001523 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001524 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1525 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1526 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001527 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001528 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001529 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001530 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1531 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001532 } else {
1533 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001534 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1535
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001536 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001537 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1538 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1539 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001540 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1541 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001542 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001543 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001544 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001545 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
1546 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001547 FromType = ToType;
1548 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1549 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001550 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001551 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001552
1553 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1554 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001555 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001556 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001557
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001558 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001559}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001560
1561static bool
1562IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1563 QualType &ToType,
1564 bool InOverloadResolution,
1565 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1566 bool CStyle) {
1567
1568 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1569 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1570 return false;
1571 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1572 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1573 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1574 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1575 itend = UD->field_end();
1576 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001577 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1578 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001579 ToType = it->getType();
1580 return true;
1581 }
1582 }
1583 return false;
1584}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001585
1586/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1587/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1588/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1589/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001590bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001591 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001592 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001593 if (!To) {
1594 return false;
1595 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001596
1597 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1598 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1599 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1600 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1601 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001602 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1603 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001604 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1605 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1606 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1607 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001608 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001609 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001610 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001611 }
1612
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001613 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1614 }
1615
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001616 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1617 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1618 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1619 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1620 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1621 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001622 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001623 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001624 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001625 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1626 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001627 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001628 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1629 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1630 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1631 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1632 return false;
1633
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001634 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001635 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001636 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001637 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1638 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001639 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001640
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001641 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001642 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1643 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1644 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001645 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001646 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001647 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001648 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001649 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001650 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001651 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001652 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1653 // unsigned.
David Majnemerfa01a582011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001654 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001655 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001656
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001657 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1658 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001659 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1660 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001661 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1662 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001663 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001664 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001665 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1666 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001667 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001668 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1669 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1670 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1671 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001672 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001673 }
1674 }
1675 }
1676
1677 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1678 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1679 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1680 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1681 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1682 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1683 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001684 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1685 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001686 using llvm::APSInt;
1687 if (From)
1688 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001689 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001690 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001691 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1692 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1693 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001694
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001695 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1696 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1697 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1698 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1699 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001700
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001701 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1702 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1703 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1704 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1705 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001706
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001707 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001708 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001709 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001710
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001711 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1712 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001713 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001714 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001715 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001716
1717 return false;
1718}
1719
1720/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1721/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1722/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001723bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001724 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1725 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001726 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1727 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001728 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1729 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1730 return true;
1731
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001732 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1733 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1734 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1735 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1736 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1737 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1738 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1739 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001740
1741 // Half can be promoted to float.
1742 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
1743 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1744 return true;
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001745 }
1746
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001747 return false;
1748}
1749
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001750/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1751///
1752/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1753/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001754/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001755bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001756 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001757 if (!FromComplex)
1758 return false;
1759
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001760 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001761 if (!ToComplex)
1762 return false;
1763
1764 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001765 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1766 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1767 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001768}
1769
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001770/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1771/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1772/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1773/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1774/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001775///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001776static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001777BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001778 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001779 ASTContext &Context,
1780 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001781 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1782 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1783 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001785 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1786 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001787 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001788
1789 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001790 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001791 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001792 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001793
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001794 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1795 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1796
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001797 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001798 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001799 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001800 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001801 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001802
1803 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1804 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001805 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1806 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001807 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1808 }
1809
1810 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001811 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1812 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001813
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001814 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1815 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1816 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001817}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001818
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001819static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001820 bool InOverloadResolution,
1821 ASTContext &Context) {
1822 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1823 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1824 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001825 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001826 return !InOverloadResolution;
1827
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001828 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1829 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1830 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001831}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001832
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001833/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1834/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1835/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1836/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1837/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1838/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001839///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001840/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1841/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1842/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1843/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1844/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1845/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001846/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1847/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1848/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001849bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001850 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001851 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001852 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001853 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001854 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1855 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001856 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001857
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001858 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1859 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001860 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001861 ConvertedType = ToType;
1862 return true;
1863 }
1864
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001865 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1866 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001867 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001868 ConvertedType = ToType;
1869 return true;
1870 }
1871 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1872 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001873 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001874 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001875 ConvertedType = ToType;
1876 return true;
1877 }
1878
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001879 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1880 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001881 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001882 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001883 ConvertedType = ToType;
1884 return true;
1885 }
1886
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001887 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001888 if (!ToTypePtr)
1889 return false;
1890
1891 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001892 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001893 ConvertedType = ToType;
1894 return true;
1895 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001896
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001897 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001898 // , including objective-c pointers.
1899 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001900 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
1901 !getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001902 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1903 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1904 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001905 ToType, Context);
1906 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001907 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001908 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001909 if (!FromTypePtr)
1910 return false;
1911
1912 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001913
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001914 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001915 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1916 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1917 return false;
1918
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001919 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1920 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1921 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001922 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1923 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001924 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001925 ToPointeeType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001926 ToType, Context,
1927 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001928 return true;
1929 }
1930
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001931 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +00001932 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001933 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
1934 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1935 ToPointeeType,
1936 ToType, Context);
1937 return true;
1938 }
1939
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001940 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1941 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001942 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001943 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001944 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001945 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001946 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001947 return true;
1948 }
1949
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001950 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001951 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001952 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1953 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1954 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1955 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1956 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1957 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1958 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1959 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1960 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001961 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1962 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001963 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1964 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001965 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001966 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001967 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001968 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001969 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001970 ToType, Context);
1971 return true;
1972 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001973
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00001974 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1975 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1976 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1977 ToPointeeType,
1978 ToType, Context);
1979 return true;
1980 }
1981
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001982 return false;
1983}
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001984
1985/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
1986static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
1987 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
1988
1989 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
1990 if (TQs == Qs)
1991 return T;
1992
1993 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
1994 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
1995
1996 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
1997}
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001998
1999/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2000/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2001/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002002bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002003 QualType& ConvertedType,
2004 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2005 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
2006 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002007
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002008 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2009 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2010
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002011 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002012 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2013 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002014 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002015 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002016
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002017 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002018 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2019 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2020 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2021 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2022 return false;
2023
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002024 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002025 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002026 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002027 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002028 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002029 return true;
2030 }
2031 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002032 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002033 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002034 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002035 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002036 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002037 return true;
2038 }
2039 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2040 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2041 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002042 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2043 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2044 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2045 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2046 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2047 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002048 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002049 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2050 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002051 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002052 return true;
2053 }
2054
2055 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2056 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2057 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2058 // complain about it.
2059 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002060 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002061 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2062 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002063 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002064 return true;
2065 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002067 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002068 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002069 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002070 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002071 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002072 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002073 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002074 // to a block pointer type.
2075 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002076 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002077 return true;
2078 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002079 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002080 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002081 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002082 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002083 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002084 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002085 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002086 return true;
2087 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002088 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002089 return false;
2090
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002091 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002092 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002093 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002094 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2095 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002096 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2097 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002098 return false;
2099
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002100 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2101 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2102 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2103 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2104 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2105 // We always complain about this conversion.
2106 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002107 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002108 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002109 return true;
2110 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002111 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2112 // as in I* to id.
2113 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2114 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2115 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2116 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002117
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002118 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002119 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002120 return true;
2121 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002122
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002123 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002124 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2125 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2126 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002127 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002128 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002129 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002130 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002131 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2132 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2133 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2134 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2135 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2136 return false;
2137
2138 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2139 // function types are obviously different.
2140 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2141 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2142 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2143 return false;
2144
2145 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2146 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2147 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2148 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2149 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2150 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2151 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2152 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2153 HasObjCConversion = true;
2154 } else {
2155 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2156 return false;
2157 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002159 // Check argument types.
2160 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2161 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2162 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2163 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2164 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2165 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2166 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2167 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2168 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2169 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2170 HasObjCConversion = true;
2171 } else {
2172 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2173 return false;
2174 }
2175 }
2176
2177 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2178 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2179 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002180 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002181 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2182 return true;
2183 }
2184 }
2185
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002186 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002187}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002188
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002189/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2190/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2191///
2192/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2193///
2194/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2195///
2196/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2197/// this conversion.
2198bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2199 QualType &ConvertedType) {
2200 if (!getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2201 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2202 return false;
2203
2204 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2205 QualType ToPointee;
2206 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2207 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2208 else
2209 return false;
2210
2211 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2212 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2213 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002214 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002215 return false;
2216
2217 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2218 QualType FromPointee;
2219 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2220 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2221 else
2222 return false;
2223
2224 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2225 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2226 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2227 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2228 return false;
2229
2230 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2231 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2232 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2233 return false;
2234
2235 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2236 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2237 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2238 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2239
2240 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2241 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2242 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2243 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2244 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2245 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2246 IncompatibleObjC))
2247 return false;
2248
2249 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2250 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2251 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2252 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2253 return true;
2254}
2255
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002256bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2257 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2258 QualType ToPointeeType;
2259 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2260 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2261 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2262 else
2263 return false;
2264
2265 QualType FromPointeeType;
2266 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2267 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2268 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2269 else
2270 return false;
2271 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2272 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2273 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2274
2275 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2276 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2277 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2278 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2279
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002280 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2281 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002282
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002283 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002284 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002285
2286 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2287 // function types are obviously different.
2288 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2289 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2290 return false;
2291
2292 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2293 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2294 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2295 return false;
2296
2297 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian12834e12011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002298 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2299 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002300 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2301 } else {
2302 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2303 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
2304 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2305 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2306 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2307
2308 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2309 // OK exact match.
2310 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2311 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2312 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2313 return false;
2314 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2315 }
2316 else
2317 return false;
2318 }
2319
2320 // Check argument types.
2321 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2322 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2323 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2324 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2325 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2326 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2327 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2328 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2329 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2330 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2331 return false;
2332 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2333 } else
2334 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2335 return false;
2336 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002337 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2338 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2339 ToFunctionType))
2340 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian600ba202011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002341
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002342 ConvertedType = ToType;
2343 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002344}
2345
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002346enum {
2347 ft_default,
2348 ft_different_class,
2349 ft_parameter_arity,
2350 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2351 ft_return_type,
2352 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2353};
2354
2355/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2356/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2357/// parameter types, and different return types.
2358void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2359 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002360 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2361 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2362 PDiag << ft_default;
2363 return;
2364 }
2365
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002366 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2367 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2368 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2369 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2370 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2371 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2372 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2373 return;
2374 }
2375 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2376 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002377 }
2378
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002379 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2380 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2381 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2382 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2383
2384 // Remove references.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002385 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2386 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2387
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002388 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2389 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2390 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2391 PDiag << ft_default;
2392 return;
2393 }
2394
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002395 // No extra info for same types.
2396 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2397 PDiag << ft_default;
2398 return;
2399 }
2400
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002401 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2402 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2403
2404 // Both types need to be function types.
2405 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2406 PDiag << ft_default;
2407 return;
2408 }
2409
2410 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2411 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2412 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2413 return;
2414 }
2415
2416 // Handle different parameter types.
2417 unsigned ArgPos;
2418 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2419 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2420 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2421 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2422 return;
2423 }
2424
2425 // Handle different return type.
2426 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2427 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2428 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2429 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2430 return;
2431 }
2432
2433 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2434 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2435 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2436 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2437 return;
2438 }
2439
2440 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2441 PDiag << ft_default;
2442}
2443
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002444/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregor2039ca02011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002445/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002446/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2447/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002448/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the the parameter index
2449/// of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002450bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002451 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2452 unsigned *ArgPos) {
2453 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1) {
2454 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2455 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2456 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2457 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
2458 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2459 return false;
2460 }
2461 }
2462 return true;
2463 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002464
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002465 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2466 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2467 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2468 QualType ToType = (*O);
2469 QualType FromType = (*N);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002470 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) {
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002471 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2472 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002473 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2474 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2475 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2476 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002477 continue;
2478 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002479 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2480 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002481 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002482 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2039ca02011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002483 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2484 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(),
2485 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType()))
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002486 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002487 }
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002488 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002489 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002490 }
2491 }
2492 return true;
2493}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002494
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002495/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2496/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002497/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002498/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2499/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2500/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002501bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002502 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002503 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002504 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002505 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002506 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002507
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002508 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2509
Chandler Carruthffab8732011-04-09 07:32:05 +00002510 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2511 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
2512 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
2513 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
Chandler Carruth66a7b042011-04-09 07:48:17 +00002514 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2515 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00002516
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002517 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2518 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002519 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2520 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002521
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002522 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2523 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002524 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2525 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002526 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2527 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002528 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002529 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002530 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002531
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002532 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002533 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002534 }
2535 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002536 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2537 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2538 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2539 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002540 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2541 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2542 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002543 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002544 return false;
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002545 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2546 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2547 } else {
2548 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002549 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002550 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2551 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2552 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002553 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002554
2555 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2556 // reasons.
2557 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2558 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2559
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002560 return false;
2561}
2562
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002563/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2564/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2565/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2566/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2567/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2568bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002569 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002570 bool InOverloadResolution,
2571 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002572 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002573 if (!ToTypePtr)
2574 return false;
2575
2576 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002577 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2578 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2579 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002580 ConvertedType = ToType;
2581 return true;
2582 }
2583
2584 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002585 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002586 if (!FromTypePtr)
2587 return false;
2588
2589 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2590 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2591 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2592 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002593
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002594 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2595 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2596 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002597 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2598 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2599 return true;
2600 }
2601
2602 return false;
2603}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002604
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002605/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2606/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002607/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002608/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2609/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2610/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002611bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002612 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002613 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002614 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002615 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002616 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002617 if (!FromPtrType) {
2618 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002619 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002620 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002621 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002622 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002623 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002624 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002625
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002626 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002627 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2628 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002629
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002630 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2631 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002632
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002633 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2634 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2635 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002636
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002637 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002638 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002639 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2640 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2641 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2642 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002643
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002644 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2645 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002646 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2647 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2648 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2649 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002650 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002651
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002652 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002653 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2654 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2655 << From->getSourceRange();
2656 return true;
2657 }
2658
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002659 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002660 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2661 Paths.front(),
2662 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002663
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002664 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002665 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002666 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002667 return false;
2668}
2669
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002670/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2671/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2672/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002673///
2674/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2675/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2676/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002677bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002678Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002679 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002680 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2681 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002682 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2683
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002684 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2685 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002686 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002687 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002688
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002689 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2690 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2691 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2692 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002693 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002694 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002695 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2696 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2697 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002698 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002699 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2700 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002701 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002702
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002703 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2704 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2705
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002706 // Objective-C ARC:
2707 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2708 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2709 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2710 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2711 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2712 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2713 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2714 } else {
2715 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2716 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2717 return false;
2718 }
2719 }
2720
Douglas Gregorf30053d2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002721 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2722 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2723 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2724 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2725 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2726 }
2727
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002728 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2729 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002730 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002731 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002732
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002733 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2734 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002735 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002736 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002737 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002738
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002739 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2740 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002741 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002742 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002743 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002744
2745 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2746 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2747 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2748 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2749 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002750 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002751}
2752
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002753static OverloadingResult
2754IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2755 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2756 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2757 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2758 bool AllowExplicit) {
2759 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
2760 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2761 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2762 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2763 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2764
2765 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2766 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2767 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2768 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2769 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2770 Constructor
2771 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2772 else
2773 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2774
2775 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2776 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2777 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2778 if (Usable) {
2779 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2780 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2781 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002782 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002783 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true);
2784 else
2785 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002786 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002787 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true);
2788 }
2789 }
2790
2791 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2792
2793 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2794 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2795 case OR_Success: {
2796 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2797 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
2798 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2799
2800 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2801 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2802 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2803 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2804 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2805 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2806 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2807 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2808 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2809 return OR_Success;
2810 }
2811
2812 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2813 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2814 case OR_Deleted:
2815 return OR_Deleted;
2816 case OR_Ambiguous:
2817 return OR_Ambiguous;
2818 }
2819
2820 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
2821}
2822
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002823/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2824/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2825/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2826/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2827/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2828/// false and User is unspecified.
2829///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002830/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2831/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2832/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002833static OverloadingResult
2834IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002835 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2836 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002837 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002838 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2839 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2840
2841 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2842 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002843 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002844 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2845 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2846 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2847 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2848 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2849 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2850 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2851 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002852 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002853 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002854 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002855 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2856
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7a6f2a32011-04-22 17:45:37 +00002857 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag());
2858 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2859 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2860 // to try to recover.
2861 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002862 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2863 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2864 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002865
2866 Expr **Args = &From;
2867 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
2868 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002869 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002870 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work.
2871 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
2872 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
2873 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
2874 return Result;
2875 // Never mind.
2876 CandidateSet.clear();
2877
2878 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
2879 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002880 Args = InitList->getInits();
2881 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
2882 ListInitializing = true;
2883 }
2884
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002885 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002886 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002887 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002888 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2889 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2890
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002891 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2892 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2893 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002894 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002895 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002896 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002897 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2898 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002899 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002900
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002901 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
2902 if (ListInitializing)
2903 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2904 else
2905 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
2906 if (Usable) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002907 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002908 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2909 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002910 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
2911 CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002912 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002913 !ConstructorsOnly &&
2914 !ListInitializing);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002915 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002916 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2917 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002918 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002919 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
2920 CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002921 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002922 !ConstructorsOnly && !ListInitializing);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002923 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002924 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002925 }
2926 }
2927
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002928 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002929 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002930 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2931 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002932 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002933 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002934 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002935 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002936 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2937 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002938 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002939 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002940 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002941 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002942 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2943 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002944 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2945 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2946 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2947
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002948 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2949 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002950 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2951 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002952 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002953 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002954
2955 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2956 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002957 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2958 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2959 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002960 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002961 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2962 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002963 }
2964 }
2965 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002966 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002967
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00002968 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2969
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002970 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002971 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002972 case OR_Success:
2973 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2974 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2975 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00002976 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002977
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002978 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2979 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2980 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2981 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2982 // the argument of the constructor.
2983 //
2984 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002985 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
2986 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2987 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2988 } else {
2989 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2990 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2991 else {
2992 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2993 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
2994 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002995 }
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00002996 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002997 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00002998 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002999 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3000 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3001 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3002 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003003 }
3004 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003005 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00003006 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003007
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003008 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3009 //
3010 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3011 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3012 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3013 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3014 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003015 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003016 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003017 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003018 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003019
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003020 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3021 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3022 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3023 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3024 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3025 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3026 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3027 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3028 // 13.3.3.1).
3029 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3030 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003031 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003032 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003033
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003034 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3035 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3036 case OR_Deleted:
3037 // No conversion here! We're done.
3038 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003039
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003040 case OR_Ambiguous:
3041 return OR_Ambiguous;
3042 }
3043
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003044 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003045}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003046
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003047bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003048Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003049 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003050 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003051 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003052 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003053 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003054 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3055 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3056 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3057 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3058 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
3059 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3060 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3061 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3062 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003063 return false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003064 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003065 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003066}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003067
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003068/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3069/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3070/// is possible.
3071static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3072compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3073 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3074 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3075 if (!S.getLangOptions().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x)
3076 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3077
3078 // Objective-C++:
3079 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3080 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3081 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3082 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3083 // to keep code working.
3084 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3085 if (!Conv1)
3086 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3087
3088 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3089 if (!Conv2)
3090 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3091
3092 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3093 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3094 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3095 if (Block1 != Block2)
3096 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3097 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3098 }
3099
3100 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3101}
3102
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003103/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3104/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3105/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003106static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3107CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3108 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3109 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003110{
3111 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3112 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3113 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3114 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3115 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3116 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3117 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3118 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003119 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003120 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3121 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3122 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3123 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3124 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003125 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3126 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003127 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003128 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003129
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003130 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3131 // the same kind.
3132 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3133 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3134
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003135 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3136 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3137
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003138 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3139 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3140 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003141 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003142 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3143 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003144 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003145 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3146 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3147 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3148 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3149 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3150 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003151 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003152 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003153 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3154 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3155 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003156 else
3157 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3158 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3159 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003160 }
3161
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003162 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3163 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3164 // for some X and L2 does not.
3165 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003166 !ICS1.isBad() &&
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003167 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3168 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003169 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3170 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3171 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3172 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3173 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3174 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003175 }
3176
3177 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003178}
3179
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003180static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3181 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3182 Qualifiers Quals;
3183 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003184 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003185 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003186
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003187 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3188}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003189
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003190// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3191// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3192static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3193compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3194 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3195 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3196 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3197 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3198
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003199 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003200 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor377c1092011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003201 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3202 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3203 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3204 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003205
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003206 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3207 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3208 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3209 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3210 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3211 else
3212 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003213 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003214 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3215
3216 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3217 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3218 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3219 }
3220
3221 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3222 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3223 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3224 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3225
3226 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3227 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3228 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3229 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003230
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003231 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3232}
3233
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003234/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3235/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3236static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3237 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3238 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3239 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3240 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003241 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003242 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003243 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003244 // reference*.
3245 //
3246 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3247 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3248 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3249 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3250 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003251 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3252 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3253 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003254
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003255 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3256 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3257 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3258 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3259}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003260
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003261/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3262/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3263/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003264static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3265CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3266 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3267 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003268{
3269 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3270 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3271
3272 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3273 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3274 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3275 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3276 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003277 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003278 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003279 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003280
3281 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3282 // defined below), or, if not that,
3283 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3284 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3285 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3286 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3287 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3288 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003289
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003290 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3291 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3292 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003293
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003294 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3295 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3296 // that is such a conversion.
3297 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3298 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3299 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3300 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3301
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003302 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3303 //
3304 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003305 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3306 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3307 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003308 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003309 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003310 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003311 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003312 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3313 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3314 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003315 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3316 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003317 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3318 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3319 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003320 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003321 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003322 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003323 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3324 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003325 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3326 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3327 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003328 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3329 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003330
3331 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3332 // conversion, if we need to.
3333 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003334 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003335 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003336 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003337
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003338 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3339 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003340
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003341 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003342 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003343 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003344 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3345
3346 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3347 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003348 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3349 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3350 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3351 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3352 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3353 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3354 FromObjCPtr2);
3355 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3356 FromObjCPtr1);
3357 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3358 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3359 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3360 }
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003361 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003362 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003363
3364 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3365 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003366 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003367 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003368 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003369
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003370 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003371 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3372 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3373 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3374 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3375 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003376
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003377 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3378 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3379 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3380 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3381 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3382 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003383 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3384 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003385 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3386 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003387 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003388 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3389 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003390 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003391 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3392 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3393 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3394 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3395 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3396 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3397 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3398 }
3399
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003400 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3401 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003402 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003403 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003404 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003405 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003406 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3407 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3408 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003409 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003410 }
3411 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003412
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003413 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3414 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3415 // is between types of the same size.
3416 // For example:
3417 // void f(float);
3418 // void f(int);
3419 // int main {
3420 // long a;
3421 // f(a);
3422 // }
3423 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3424 // as clang will do in standard mode.
3425 if (S.getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode &&
3426 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3427 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3428 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3429 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3430 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3431
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003432 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3433}
3434
3435/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3436/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003437/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3438ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003439CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3440 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3441 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003442 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003443 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3444 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3445 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3446 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3447 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3448 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3449 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3450 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3451
3452 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3453 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003454 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3455 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003456 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3457 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003458 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003459 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3460 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003461
3462 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3463 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003464 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003465 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3466
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003467 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3468 // for comparison.
3469 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003470 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003471 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003472 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003473
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003474 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003475 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003476
3477 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3478 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3479 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3480 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3481 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3482 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3483 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3484 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3485 }
3486
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003487 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003488 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3489 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3490 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003491 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003492 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3493 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3494 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3495 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3496 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3497 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3498 // about how the sequences rank.
3499 ;
3500 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3501 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3502 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3503 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3504 // qualifiers.
3505 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003506
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003507 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3508 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3509 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3510 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3511 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3512 // qualifiers.
3513 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003514
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003515 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3516 } else {
3517 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3518 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3519 }
3520
3521 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003522 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003523 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003524 }
3525
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003526 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3527 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3528 switch (Result) {
3529 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003530 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003531 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3532 break;
3533
3534 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3535 break;
3536
3537 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003538 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003539 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3540 break;
3541 }
3542
3543 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003544}
3545
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003546/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3547/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003548/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3549/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3550/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003551ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003552CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3553 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3554 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003555 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003556 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003557 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003558 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003559
3560 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3561 // conversion, if we need to.
3562 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003563 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003564 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003565 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003566
3567 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003568 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3569 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3570 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3571 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003572
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003573 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003574 //
3575 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3576 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003577 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003578 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003579 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003580 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3581 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3582 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3583 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003584 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003585 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003586 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003587 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003588 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003589 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003590 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003591 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003592
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003593 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003594 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003595 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003596 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003597 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003598 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3599 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003600
3601 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3602 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003603 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003604 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003605 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003606 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003607 }
3608 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3609 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3610 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3611 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3612 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3613 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3614 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3615 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3616 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3617 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3618
3619 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3620 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3621 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3622 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3623 // Objective-C pointer types.
3624 bool FromAssignLeft
3625 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3626 bool FromAssignRight
3627 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3628 bool ToAssignLeft
3629 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3630 bool ToAssignRight
3631 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3632
3633 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3634 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3635 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3636 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3637 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3638 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3639 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3640 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3641
3642 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3643 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3644 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3645 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3646 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3647 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3648
3649 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3650 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3651 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3652 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3653 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3654 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3655 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3656 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3657
3658 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3659 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3660 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3661 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3662 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3663 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003664
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003665 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3666 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3667 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3668 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3669 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3670 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3671
3672 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3673 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3674 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3675 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3676 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003677 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003678 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003679
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003680 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003681 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3682 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3683 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003684 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003685 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003686 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003687 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003688 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003689 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003690 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003691 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3692 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3693 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3694 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3695 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3696 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3697 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3698 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3699 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003700 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003701 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003702 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003703 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003704 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003705 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3706 }
3707 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3708 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003709 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003710 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003711 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003712 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3713 }
3714 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003715
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003716 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003717 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003718 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3719 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3720 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003721 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3722 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3723 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003724 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003725 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003726 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3727 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003728
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003729 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003730 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3731 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3732 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003733 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3734 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3735 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003736 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003737 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003738 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3739 }
3740 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003741
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003742 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3743}
3744
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003745/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3746/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3747/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3748/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3749/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3750/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3751/// type being initialized.
3752Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3753Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3754 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003755 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003756 bool &ObjCConversion,
3757 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003758 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3759 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3760 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3761
3762 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3763 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3764 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3765 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3766 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3767
3768 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3769 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3770 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3771 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003772 DerivedToBase = false;
3773 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003774 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003775 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3776 // Nothing to do.
3777 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003778 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3779 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003780 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3781 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3782 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3783 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003784 else
3785 return Ref_Incompatible;
3786
3787 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3788 // least).
3789
3790 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3791 // for comparison.
3792 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3793 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3794 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3795 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3796
3797 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3798 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3799 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3800 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3801 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3802 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3803 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003804 //
3805 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3806 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3807 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3808 // space 2.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003809 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3810 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3811 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3812 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3813 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3814 }
3815
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003816 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003817 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003818 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003819 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3820 else
3821 return Ref_Related;
3822}
3823
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003824/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003825/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3826static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003827FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3828 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3829 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3830 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003831 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3832 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3833 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3834
3835 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3836 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3837 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3838 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3839 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3840 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3841 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3842 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3843 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3844
3845 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3846 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3847 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3848 if (ConvTemplate)
3849 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3850 else
3851 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3852
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003853 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003854 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3855 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3856 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003857
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003858 if (AllowRvalues) {
3859 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3860 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003861 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00003862
3863 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
3864 // functions that return lvalues.
3865 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
3866 const ReferenceType *RefType
3867 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
3868 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
3869 continue;
3870 }
3871
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003872 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003873 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3874 DeclLoc,
3875 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3876 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3877 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003878 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003879 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003880 continue;
3881 } else {
3882 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3883 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3884 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3885
3886 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3887 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3888 if (!RefType ||
3889 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3890 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3891 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003892 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003893
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003894 if (ConvTemplate)
3895 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003896 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003897 else
3898 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003899 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003900 }
3901
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003902 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3903
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003904 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003905 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003906 case OR_Success:
3907 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3908 //
3909 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3910 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3911 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3912 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3913 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3914 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3915 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3916 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3917 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3918 return false;
3919
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003920 if (Best->Function)
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00003921 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003922 ICS.setUserDefined();
3923 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3924 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003925 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003926 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003927 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003928 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3929 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3930 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3931 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3932 return true;
3933
3934 case OR_Ambiguous:
3935 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3936 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3937 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3938 if (Cand->Viable)
3939 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3940 return true;
3941
3942 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3943 case OR_Deleted:
3944 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3945 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3946 return false;
3947 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003948
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003949 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003950}
3951
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003952/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3953/// initialization.
3954static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00003955TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003956 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3957 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003958 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003959 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3960
3961 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3962 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3963 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3964
3965 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3966 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3967
3968 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3969 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3970 // type of the resulting function.
3971 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3972 DeclAccessPair Found;
3973 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3974 false, Found))
3975 T2 = Fn->getType();
3976 }
3977
3978 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3979 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3980 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003981 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003982 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003983 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003984 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003985 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003986 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003987
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003988
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003989 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003990 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3991 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3992
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003993 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003994 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003995 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3996 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3997 //
3998 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3999 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4000 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004001 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004002 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4003 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4004 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4005 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4006 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4007 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4008 ICS.setStandard();
4009 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004010 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4011 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4012 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004013 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4014 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4015 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4016 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4017 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4018 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4019 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004020 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4021 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4022 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004023 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004024 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004025 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004026
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004027 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4028 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4029 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4030 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004031 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004032 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004033
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004034 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4035 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4036 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4037 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4038 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4039 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4040 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4041 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004042 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004043 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004044 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4045 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4046 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004047 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004048 }
4049 }
4050
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004051 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4052 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004053 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004054 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004055 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4056 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4057 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4058 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4059 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4060 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4061 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004062 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4063 // go together.
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004064 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004065 return ICS;
4066
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004067 // -- If the initializer expression
4068 //
4069 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004070 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004071 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4072 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4073 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4074 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4075 ICS.setStandard();
4076 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004077 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004078 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4079 : ICK_Identity;
4080 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4081 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4082 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4083 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4084 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4085 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4086 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4087 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4088 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4089 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4090 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004091 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
4092 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004093 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004094 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4095 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004096 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004097 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004098 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004099 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004100 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004101 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004102
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004103 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4104 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004105 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4106 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004107 // "cv3 T3",
4108 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004109 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004110 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004111 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004112 // class subobject).
4113 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004114 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004115 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4116 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4117 AllowExplicit)) {
4118 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4119 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4120 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4121 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004122 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004123 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4124 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4125
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004126 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004127 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004128
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004129 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4130 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4131 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4132 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4133 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4134 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4135 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4136 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4137 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4138 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4139 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4140 // initialization fails.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004141 //
4142 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4143 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4144 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4145 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4146 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4147 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4148 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4149 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4150 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4151 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004152 }
4153
4154 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4155 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4156 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4157 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4158 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4159 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4160 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4161 return ICS;
4162
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004163 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4164 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4165 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4166 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4167 return ICS;
4168
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004169 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004170 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4171 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4172 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4173 // underlying type of the reference according to
4174 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4175 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4176 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4177 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4178 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004179 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4180 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004181 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004182 /*CStyle=*/false,
4183 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004184
4185 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4186 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4187 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004188 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4189 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4190 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004191 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004192 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004193 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004194 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4195 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4196 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4197 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4198 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4199 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4200 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4201 DeclType);
4202 return ICS;
4203 }
4204 }
4205 }
4206
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004207 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor3ec79102011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004208 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4209 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4210 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4211 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4212 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004213 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004214
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004215 return ICS;
4216}
4217
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004218static ImplicitConversionSequence
4219TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4220 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4221 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004222 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4223 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004224
4225/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4226/// initializer list From.
4227static ImplicitConversionSequence
4228TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4229 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4230 bool InOverloadResolution,
4231 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4232 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4233 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4234 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4235
4236 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4237 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004238 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004239
Sebastian Redl09edce02012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004240 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004241 // initialized from init lists.
4242 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag()))
4243 return Result;
4244
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004245 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4246 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4247 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4248 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4249 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004250 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004251 QualType X;
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004252 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004253 X = S.Context.getBaseElementType(ToType);
4254 else
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004255 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004256 if (!X.isNull()) {
4257 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4258 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4259 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4260 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4261 InOverloadResolution,
4262 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4263 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4264 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4265 Result = ICS;
4266 break;
4267 }
4268 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4269 if (Result.isBad() ||
4270 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4271 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4272 Result = ICS;
4273 }
4274 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004275 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004276 return Result;
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004277 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004278
4279 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4280 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4281 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4282 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4283 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4284 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004285 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4286 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4287 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4288 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4289 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4290 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4291 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004292 return Result;
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004293 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004294
4295 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4296 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4297 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4298 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004299 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004300 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4301 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4302 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4303 InitializedEntity Entity =
4304 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4305 /*Consumed=*/false);
4306 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4307 Result.setUserDefined();
4308 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4309 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4310 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4311 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4312
4313 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4314 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4315 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramerb6d65082012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004316 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004317 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004318 return Result;
4319 }
4320
4321 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4322 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004323 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4324 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4325 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4326 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4327
4328 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4329
4330 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4331 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4332 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4333 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4334
4335 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4336
4337 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4338 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4339 // type of the resulting function.
4340 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4341 DeclAccessPair Found;
4342 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4343 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4344 T2 = Fn->getType();
4345 }
4346
4347 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4348 bool dummy1 = false;
4349 bool dummy2 = false;
4350 bool dummy3 = false;
4351 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4352 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4353 dummy2, dummy3);
4354
4355 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4356 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4357 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4358 SuppressUserConversions,
4359 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4360 }
4361
4362 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4363 // initializer list.
4364 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4365 InOverloadResolution,
4366 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4367 if (Result.isFailure())
4368 return Result;
4369 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4370 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4371
4372 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4373 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4374 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4375 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4376 Result.UserDefined.After;
4377 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4378 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4379 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4380 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4381 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4382 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4383 } else
4384 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4385 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004386 return Result;
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004387 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004388
4389 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4390 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4391 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4392 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4393 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4394 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004395 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4396 if (NumInits == 1)
4397 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4398 SuppressUserConversions,
4399 InOverloadResolution,
4400 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4401 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4402 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4403 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4404 Result.setStandard();
4405 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4406 }
4407 return Result;
4408 }
4409
4410 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4411 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4412 return Result;
4413}
4414
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004415/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4416/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4417/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4418/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004419/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004420/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004421static ImplicitConversionSequence
4422TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004423 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004424 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004425 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4426 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004427 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4428 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4429 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4430
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004431 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004432 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004433 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4434 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004435 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004436
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004437 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4438 SuppressUserConversions,
4439 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004440 InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004441 /*CStyle=*/false,
4442 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004443}
4444
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004445static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4446 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4447 Sema &S,
4448 SourceLocation Loc,
4449 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4450 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4451 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4452 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4453
4454 return !ICS.isBad();
4455}
4456
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004457/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4458/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4459/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004460static ImplicitConversionSequence
4461TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004462 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004463 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4464 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4465 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004466 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4467 // const volatile object.
4468 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4469 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004470 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004471
4472 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4473 // to exit early.
4474 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004475
4476 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00004477 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004478 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004479 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4480
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004481 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4482 // better have an lvalue.
4483 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4484 }
4485
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004486 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004487
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004488 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004489 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004490 // parameter is
4491 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004492 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4493 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4494 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004495 // ref-qualifier
4496 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004497 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004498 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4499 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004500 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004501 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004502 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4503 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4504 // non-constant references.
4505
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004506 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004507 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004508 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004509 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004510 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004511 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
4512 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004513 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004514 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004515
4516 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4517 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004518 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004519 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4520 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4521 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004522 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004523 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004524 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004525 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4526 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004527 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004528 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004529
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004530 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4531 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4532 case RQ_None:
4533 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4534 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004535
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004536 case RQ_LValue:
4537 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4538 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004539 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004540 ImplicitParamType);
4541 return ICS;
4542 }
4543 break;
4544
4545 case RQ_RValue:
4546 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4547 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004548 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004549 ImplicitParamType);
4550 return ICS;
4551 }
4552 break;
4553 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004554
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004555 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004556 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004557 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4558 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004559 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004560 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004561 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4562 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004563 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004564 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004565 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4566 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4567 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004568 return ICS;
4569}
4570
4571/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4572/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4573/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004574ExprResult
4575Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004576 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004577 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004578 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004579 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004580 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004581 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004582
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004583 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004584 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004585 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4586 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004587 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004588 } else {
4589 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4590 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004591 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004592 }
4593
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004594 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4595 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004596 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004597 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4598 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004599 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4600 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4601 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4602 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4603 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4604 if (CVR) {
4605 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4606 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4607 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4608 << From->getSourceRange();
4609 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4610 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004611 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004612 }
4613 }
4614
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004615 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004616 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004617 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004618 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004619
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004620 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4621 ExprResult FromRes =
4622 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4623 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4624 return ExprError();
4625 From = FromRes.take();
4626 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004627
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004628 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004629 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smith4a905b62011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004630 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004631 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004632}
4633
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004634/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4635/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004636static ImplicitConversionSequence
4637TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004638 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004639 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004640 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4641 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004642 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004643 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004644 /*CStyle=*/false,
4645 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004646}
4647
4648/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4649/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004650ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004651 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4652 return ExprError();
4653
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004654 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004655 if (!ICS.isBad())
4656 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004657
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004658 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004659 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4660 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004661 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004662 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004663}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004664
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004665/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4666/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4667/// is acceptable.
4668static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4669 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4670 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4671 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4672 // conversions are fine.
4673 switch (SCS.Second) {
4674 case ICK_Identity:
4675 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4676 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
4677 return true;
4678
4679 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
4680 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4681 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4682 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4683 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4684 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4685
4686 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4687 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4688 return false;
4689
4690 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4691 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4692 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4693 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4694 case ICK_Qualification:
4695 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4696 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4697 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4698 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4699 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4700 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4701 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4702 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4703 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4704 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4705 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4706 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4707 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4708 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4709
4710 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4711 break;
4712 }
4713
4714 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4715}
4716
4717/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4718/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4719/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4720ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4721 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4722 CCEKind CCE) {
4723 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus0x && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
4724 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4725
4726 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4727 return ExprError();
4728
4729 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4730 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4731 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4732 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4733 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4734 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4735 // narrowing conversions.
4736 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4737 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4738 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4739 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4740 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4741 /*CStyle=*/false,
4742 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4743 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4744 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4745 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4746 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
4747 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4748 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4749 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4750 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4751 break;
4752 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4753 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4754 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4755 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
4756 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4757 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4758 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4759 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4760 break;
4761 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4762 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4763 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
4764 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4765 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4766 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4767 return ExprError();
4768
4769 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4770 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4771 }
4772
4773 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4774 if (Result.isInvalid())
4775 return Result;
4776
4777 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4778 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004779 bool Diagnosed = false;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004780 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue)) {
4781 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4782 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4783 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4784 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4785 break;
4786
4787 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
4788 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_cce_narrowing)
4789 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
4790 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, QualType()) << T;
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004791 Diagnosed = true;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004792 break;
4793
4794 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
4795 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_cce_narrowing)
4796 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004797 Diagnosed = true;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004798 break;
4799 }
4800
4801 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
4802 llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
4803 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
4804 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
4805
4806 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) {
4807 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
4808 // the AST.
4809 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004810 } else {
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004811 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004812
4813 if (Notes.empty()) {
4814 // It's a constant expression.
4815 return Result;
4816 }
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004817 }
4818
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004819 // Only issue one narrowing diagnostic.
4820 if (Diagnosed)
4821 return Result;
4822
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004823 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
4824 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
4825 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
4826 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
4827 else {
4828 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
4829 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
4830 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
4831 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
4832 }
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004833 return Result;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004834}
4835
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004836/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
4837/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
4838/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
4839static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4840 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4841 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
4842 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
4843 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
4844 }
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004845}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004846
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004847/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
4848/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4849static ImplicitConversionSequence
4850TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
4851 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
4852 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
4853 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
4854 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
4855 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4856 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4857 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
4858 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4859 /*CStyle=*/false,
4860 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
4861
4862 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
4863 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4864 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4865 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4866 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4867 break;
4868
4869 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4870 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
4871 break;
4872
4873 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4874 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
4875 break;
4876 }
4877
4878 return ICS;
4879}
4880
4881/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
4882/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4883ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004884 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4885 return ExprError();
4886
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004887 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004888 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4889 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004890 if (!ICS.isBad())
4891 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004892 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004893}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004894
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004895/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
4896/// type of a permitted flavor.
4897static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) {
4898 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
4899 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
4900}
4901
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004902/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004903/// enumeration type.
4904///
4905/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
4906/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
4907/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4908///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004909/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
4910/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004911///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004912/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
4913///
4914/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
4915/// have integral or enumeration type.
4916///
4917/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
4918/// incomplete class type.
4919///
4920/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
4921/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
4922/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
4923///
4924/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
4925/// showing which conversion was picked.
4926///
4927/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
4928/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
4929///
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004930/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004931/// usable conversion function.
4932///
4933/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
4934/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
4935///
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004936/// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped
4937/// enumerations should be considered.
4938///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004939/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
4940/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004941ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004942Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004943 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
4944 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
4945 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
4946 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
4947 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004948 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004949 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag,
4950 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004951 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
4952 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004953 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004954
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00004955 // Process placeholders immediately.
4956 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
4957 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
4958 if (result.isInvalid()) return result;
4959 From = result.take();
4960 }
4961
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004962 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
4963 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004964 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations))
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00004965 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004966
4967 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
4968
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004969 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004970 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
4971 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
4972 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Richard Smithf4c51d92012-02-04 09:53:13 +00004973 if (NotIntDiag.getDiagID())
4974 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag) << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004975 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004976 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004977
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004978 // We must have a complete class type.
4979 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004980 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004981
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004982 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4983 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
4984 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
4985 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4986 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004987
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004988 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (Conversions->size() > 1);
4989
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004990 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004991 E = Conversions->end();
4992 I != E;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004993 ++I) {
4994 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004995 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) {
4996 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(
4997 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(),
4998 AllowScopedEnumerations)) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004999 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
5000 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5001 else
5002 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5003 }
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005004 }
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005005 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005006
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005007 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5008 case 0:
Richard Smithf4c51d92012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005009 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && ExplicitConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005010 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5011 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5012 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005013
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005014 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5015 // conversion; use it.
5016 QualType ConvTy
5017 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5018 std::string TypeStr;
Douglas Gregor75acd922011-09-27 23:30:47 +00005019 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005020
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005021 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
5022 << T << ConvTy
5023 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5024 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5025 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
5026 ")");
5027 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
5028 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005029
5030 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005031 // explicit conversion function.
5032 if (isSFINAEContext())
5033 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005034
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005035 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005036 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5037 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005038 if (Result.isInvalid())
5039 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005040 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5041 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5042 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5043 Result.get(), 0,
5044 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005045 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005046
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005047 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5048 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005049
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005050 case 1: {
5051 // Apply this conversion.
5052 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5053 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005054
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005055 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5056 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5057 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005058 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005059 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
5060 if (isSFINAEContext())
5061 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005062
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005063 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
5064 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
5065 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005066
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005067 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5068 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005069 if (Result.isInvalid())
5070 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005071 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5072 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5073 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5074 Result.get(), 0,
5075 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005076 break;
5077 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005078
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005079 default:
Richard Smithf4c51d92012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005080 if (!AmbigDiag.getDiagID())
5081 return Owned(From);
5082
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005083 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
5084 << T << From->getSourceRange();
5085 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5086 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
5087 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5088 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5089 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
5090 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
5091 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005092 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005093 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005094
Richard Smithf4c51d92012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005095 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) &&
5096 NotIntDiag.getDiagID())
5097 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag) << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005098
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005099 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005100}
5101
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005102/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005103/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5104/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5105/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005106///
5107/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
5108/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5109/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005110void
5111Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005112 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005113 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005114 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005115 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005116 bool PartialOverloading,
5117 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005118 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005119 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005120 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005121 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005122 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005123
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005124 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005125 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5126 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5127 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5128 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5129 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005130 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5131 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5132 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005133 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005134 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005135 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005136 return;
5137 }
5138 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5139 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005140 }
5141
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005142 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005143 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005144
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005145 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005146 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005147
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005148 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
5149 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5150 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5151 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5152 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005153 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005154 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005155 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5156 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005157 return;
5158 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005159
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005160 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005161 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005162 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005163 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005164 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005165 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005166 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005167 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005168
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005169 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5170
5171 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5172 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5173 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005174 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005175 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005176 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005177 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005178 return;
5179 }
5180
5181 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5182 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5183 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5184 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5185 // exactly m parameters.
5186 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005187 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005188 // Not enough arguments.
5189 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005190 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005191 return;
5192 }
5193
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005194 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
5195 if (getLangOptions().CUDA)
5196 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5197 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5198 Candidate.Viable = false;
5199 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5200 return;
5201 }
5202
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005203 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5204 // arguments.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005205 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005206 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5207 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5208 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5209 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5210 // parameter of F.
5211 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005212 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005213 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005214 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005215 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5216 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005217 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount,
5218 AllowExplicit);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005219 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5220 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005221 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005222 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005223 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005224 } else {
5225 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5226 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5227 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005228 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005229 }
5230 }
5231}
5232
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005233/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5234/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005235void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005236 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005237 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5238 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005239 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005240 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5241 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005242 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005243 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005244 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005245 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005246 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5247 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005248 else
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005249 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005250 SuppressUserConversions);
5251 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005252 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005253 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5254 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005255 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005256 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005257 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005258 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005259 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5260 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005261 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005262 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005263 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0, Args,
5264 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005265 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005266 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005267}
5268
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005269/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5270/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005271void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005272 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005273 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005274 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5275 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005276 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005277 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005278 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005279
5280 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5281 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005282
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005283 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5284 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5285 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005286 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5287 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005288 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5289 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005290 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005291 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005292 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005293 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5294 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005295 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005296 }
5297}
5298
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005299/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5300/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5301/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5302/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5303/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5304/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005305/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005306void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005307Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005308 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005309 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005310 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005311 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005312 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005313 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005314 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005315 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005316 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5317 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005318
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005319 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5320 return;
5321
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005322 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005323 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005324
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005325 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005326 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005327 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005328 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005329 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005330 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005331 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005332
5333 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5334
5335 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5336 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5337 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005338 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005339 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005340 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005341 return;
5342 }
5343
5344 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5345 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5346 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5347 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5348 // exactly m parameters.
5349 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005350 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005351 // Not enough arguments.
5352 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005353 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005354 return;
5355 }
5356
5357 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005358
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005359 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005360 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5361 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5362 else {
5363 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5364 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005365 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005366 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5367 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005368 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005369 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005370 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005371 return;
5372 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005373 }
5374
5375 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5376 // arguments.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005377 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005378 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5379 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5380 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5381 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5382 // parameter of F.
5383 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005384 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005385 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005386 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005387 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5388 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5389 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005390 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005391 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005392 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005393 break;
5394 }
5395 } else {
5396 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5397 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5398 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005399 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005400 }
5401 }
5402}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005403
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005404/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5405/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5406/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005407void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005408Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005409 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005410 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005411 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005412 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005413 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005414 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005415 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005416 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005417 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5418 return;
5419
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005420 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005421 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005422 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005423 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005424 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5425 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5426 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5427 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5428 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005429 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005430 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5431 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005432 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5433 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005434 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005435 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5436 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5437 Candidate.Viable = false;
5438 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5439 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5440 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005441 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005442 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005443 Info);
5444 return;
5445 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005446
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005447 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5448 // deduction as a candidate.
5449 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005450 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005451 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005452 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005453 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5454 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005455}
5456
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005457/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5458/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5459/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005460void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005461Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005462 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005463 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005464 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005465 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005466 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005467 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5468 return;
5469
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005470 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005471 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005472 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005473 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005474 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5475 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5476 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5477 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5478 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005479 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005480 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5481 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005482 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5483 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005484 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005485 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005486 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5487 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005488 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005489 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5490 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005491 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005492 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005493 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005494 return;
5495 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005496
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005497 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5498 // deduction as a candidate.
5499 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005500 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005501 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005502}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005503
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005504/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005505/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005506/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005507/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005508/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5509/// conversion function produces).
5510void
5511Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005512 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005513 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005514 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5515 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005516 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5517 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005518 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005519 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5520 return;
5521
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005522 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005523 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005524
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005525 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005526 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005527 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005528 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005529 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005530 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005531 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005532 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005533 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005534 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005535 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005536
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005537 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005538 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5539 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005540 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005541 //
5542 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5543 // object parameter.
5544 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5545 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5546 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5547 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5548 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005549
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005550 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005551 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5552 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005553 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005554
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005555 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005556 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005557 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005558 return;
5559 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005560
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005561 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005562 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5563 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5564 QualType FromCanon
5565 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5566 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5567 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5568 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005569 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005570 return;
5571 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005572
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005573 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5574 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5575 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5576 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5577 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5578 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5579 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5580 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005581 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005582 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005583 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5584 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005585 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005586 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005587
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005588 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5589 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005590 Candidate.Viable = false;
5591 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5592 return;
5593 }
5594
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005595 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005596
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005597 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005598 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5599 // allocator).
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005600 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005601 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005602 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005603 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005604 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005605 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005606 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5607 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005608
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005609 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005610 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5611 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005612
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005613 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5614 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005615 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005616 // shall have exact match rank.
5617 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5618 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5619 Candidate.Viable = false;
5620 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5621 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005622
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005623 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5624 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5625 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5626 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5627 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005628 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005629 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5630 Candidate.Viable = false;
5631 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5632 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005633 break;
5634
5635 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5636 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005637 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005638 break;
5639
5640 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005641 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005642 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5643 }
5644}
5645
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005646/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5647/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5648/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5649/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5650/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005651void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005652Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005653 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005654 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005655 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5656 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5657 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5658 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5659
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005660 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5661 return;
5662
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005663 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005664 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5665 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005666 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005667 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005668 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005669 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5670 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5671 Candidate.Viable = false;
5672 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5673 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5674 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005675 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005676 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005677 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005678 return;
5679 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005680
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005681 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
5682 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
5683 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005684 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005685 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005686}
5687
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005688/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
5689/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
5690/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
5691/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
5692/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
5693void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005694 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005695 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00005696 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005697 Expr *Object,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005698 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005699 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005700 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5701 return;
5702
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005703 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005704 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005705
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005706 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005707 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005708 Candidate.Function = 0;
5709 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
5710 Candidate.Viable = true;
5711 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005712 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005713 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005714
5715 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5716 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005717 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005718 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005719 Object->Classify(Context),
5720 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005721 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005722 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005723 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005724 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005725 return;
5726 }
5727
5728 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
5729 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
5730 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005731 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005732 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00005733 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005734 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005735 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00005736 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005737 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005738 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
5739 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5740
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005741 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005742 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5743
5744 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5745 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5746 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005747 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005748 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005749 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005750 return;
5751 }
5752
5753 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
5754 // we have enough arguments.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005755 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005756 // Not enough arguments.
5757 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005758 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005759 return;
5760 }
5761
5762 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5763 // arguments.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005764 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005765 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5766 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5767 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5768 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5769 // parameter of F.
5770 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005771 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005772 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005773 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005774 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5775 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5776 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005777 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005778 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005779 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005780 break;
5781 }
5782 } else {
5783 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5784 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5785 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005786 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005787 }
5788 }
5789}
5790
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005791/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5792/// member functions.
5793///
5794/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
5795/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
5796/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
5797/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
5798/// [over.match.oper]).
5799void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5800 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5801 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5802 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5803 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005804 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
5805
5806 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5807 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
5808 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
5809 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
5810 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
5811 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
5812 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
5813 // constructed as follows:
5814 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005815
5816 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
5817 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
5818 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
5819 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005820 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005821 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00005822 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005823 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005824
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00005825 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
5826 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
5827 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
5828
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005829 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005830 OperEnd = Operators.end();
5831 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005832 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005833 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005834 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005835 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005836 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005837 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005838}
5839
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005840/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
5841/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
5842/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005843/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
5844/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005845/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
5846/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
5847/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005848void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005849 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005850 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005851 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
5852 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005853 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005854 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005855
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005856 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005857 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005858 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005859 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00005860 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005861 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005862 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
5863 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5864 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
5865
5866 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5867 // arguments.
5868 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005869 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005870 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005871 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
5872 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
5873 // left operand are restricted as follows:
5874 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
5875 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
5876 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005877 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005878 //
5879 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
5880 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
5881 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
5882 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005883 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005884 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005885 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005886 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
5887 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005888 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005889 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005890 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005891 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005892 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5893 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5894 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005895 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005896 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005897 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005898 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005899 break;
5900 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005901 }
5902}
5903
5904/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
5905/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
5906/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
5907/// enumeration types.
5908class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
5909 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005910 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005911
5912 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
5913 /// built-in candidates.
5914 TypeSet PointerTypes;
5915
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005916 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
5917 /// used in the built-in candidates.
5918 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
5919
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005920 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
5921 /// used in the built-in candidates.
5922 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
5923
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005924 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005925 /// candidates.
5926 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005927
5928 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
5929 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
5930
5931 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
5932 /// were present in the candidate set.
5933 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
5934
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005935 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
5936 /// candidate set.
5937 bool HasNullPtrType;
5938
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00005939 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
5940 /// candidate type set.
5941 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005942
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005943 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
5944 ASTContext &Context;
5945
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005946 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
5947 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005948 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005949
5950public:
5951 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005952 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005953
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005954 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005955 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
5956 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005957 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005958 SemaRef(SemaRef),
5959 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005960
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005961 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005962 SourceLocation Loc,
5963 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005964 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
5965 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005966
5967 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
5968 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
5969
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005970 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005971 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
5972
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005973 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
5974 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
5975
5976 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
5977 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
5978
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005979 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
5980 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
5981
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005982 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005983 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005984
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005985 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
5986 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005987
5988 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
5989 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005990 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005991};
5992
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005993/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005994/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5995/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5996/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5997/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5998/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5999/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006000///
6001/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006002bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006003BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6004 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006005
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006006 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006007 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006008 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006009
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006010 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006011 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006012 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006013 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006014 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006015 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006016 buildObjCPtr = true;
6017 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006018 else
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006019 llvm_unreachable("type was not a pointer type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006020 }
6021 else
6022 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006023
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006024 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6025 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6026 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6027 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6028 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6029 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006030 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00006031 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00006032 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006033 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6034 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006035
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006036 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6037 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6038 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006039 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
6040 // in the types.
6041 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
6042 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006043 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006044 if (!buildObjCPtr)
6045 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
6046 else
6047 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006048 }
6049
6050 return true;
6051}
6052
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006053/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6054/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6055/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6056/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6057/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6058/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6059/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006060///
6061/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006062bool
6063BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6064 QualType Ty) {
6065 // Insert this type.
6066 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6067 return false;
6068
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006069 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6070 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006071
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006072 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006073 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6074 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6075 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6076 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6077 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6078 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006079 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6080
6081 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6082 // qualifiers.
6083 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6084 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6085 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006086
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006087 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006088 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6089 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006090 }
6091
6092 return true;
6093}
6094
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006095/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6096/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006097/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6098/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006099/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6100/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6101/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6102/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006103void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006104BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006105 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006106 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006107 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6108 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006109 // Only deal with canonical types.
6110 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6111
6112 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6113 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006114 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006115 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6116
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006117 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6118 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6119 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6120
6121 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006122 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006123
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006124 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6125 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6126 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6127
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006128 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6129 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6130 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6131
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006132 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6133 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6134 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006135 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6136 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006137 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006138 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006139 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6140 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6141 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6142 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006143 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006144 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006145 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006146 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006147 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6148 // extension.
6149 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006150 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006151 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6152 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006153 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6154 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6155 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6156 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006157
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006158 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
6159 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
6160 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6161 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
6162 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
6163 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6164 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6165 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006166
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006167 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6168 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6169 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6170 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006171
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006172 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6173 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6174 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6175 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006176 }
6177 }
6178 }
6179}
6180
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006181/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6182/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6183/// given type to the candidate set.
6184static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6185 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006186 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006187 unsigned NumArgs,
6188 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6189 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006190
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006191 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6192 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6193 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6194 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6195 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006196
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006197 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6198 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006199 ParamTypes[0]
6200 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006201 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6202 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006203 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006204 }
6205}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006206
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006207/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6208/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006209static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6210 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6211 const RecordType *TyRec;
6212 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6213 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006214 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006215 else
6216 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6217 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006218 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006219 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6220 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6221 return VRQuals;
6222 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006223
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006224 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006225 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6226 return VRQuals;
6227
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006228 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006229 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006230
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006231 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006232 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006233 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6234 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6235 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6236 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006237 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6238 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6239 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6240 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6241 // as see them.
6242 bool done = false;
6243 while (!done) {
6244 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6245 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006246 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006247 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6248 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6249 else
6250 done = true;
6251 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6252 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6253 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6254 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6255 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6256 return VRQuals;
6257 }
6258 }
6259 }
6260 return VRQuals;
6261}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006262
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006263namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006264
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006265/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6266/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6267/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6268/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6269class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006270 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6271 Sema &S;
6272 Expr **Args;
6273 unsigned NumArgs;
6274 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006275 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006276 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006277 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006278
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006279 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6280 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006281 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6282 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006283 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
6284 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
6285 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
6286 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
6287 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
6288 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
6289 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
6290
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006291 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6292 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6293 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6294 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6295 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6296 // Start of promoted types.
6297 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6298 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6299 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006300
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006301 // Start of integral types.
6302 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6303 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6304 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
6305 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6306 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6307 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
6308 // End of promoted types.
6309
6310 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6311 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6312 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6313 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6314 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6315 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6316 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6317 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6318 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6319 // End of integral types.
6320 // FIXME: What about complex?
6321 };
6322 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6323 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006324
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006325 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6326 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6327 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6328 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6329 // The rules are basically:
6330 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6331 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6332 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6333 // - use the larger type
6334 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6335 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6336 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6337 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6338 // better not to make any assumptions).
6339 enum PromotedType {
6340 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
6341 };
6342 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
6343 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
6344 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6345 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6346 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6347 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
6348 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
6349 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
6350 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
6351 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
6352 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
6353 };
6354
6355 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6356 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6357 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6358
6359 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006360 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006361
6362 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6363 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006364 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6365 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006366 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6367 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6368
6369 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6370 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6371 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6372
6373 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6374 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6375 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6376 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6377 }
6378
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006379 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6380 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006381 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
6382 bool HasVolatile) {
6383 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6384 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6385 S.Context.IntTy
6386 };
6387
6388 // Non-volatile version.
6389 if (NumArgs == 1)
6390 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6391 else
6392 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6393
6394 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6395 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6396 if (HasVolatile) {
6397 ParamTypes[0] =
6398 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6399 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
6400 if (NumArgs == 1)
6401 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6402 else
6403 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6404 }
6405 }
6406
6407public:
6408 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
6409 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6410 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006411 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006412 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006413 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
6414 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
6415 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006416 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6417 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006418 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6419 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6420 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006421 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006422 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006423 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
6424 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006425 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006426 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6427 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006428 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006429 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
6430 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006431 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6432 }
6433
6434 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6435 //
6436 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6437 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6438 // functions of the form
6439 //
6440 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6441 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6442 //
6443 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6444 //
6445 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6446 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6447 // candidate operator functions of the form
6448 //
6449 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6450 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6451 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006452 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6453 return;
6454
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006455 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6456 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6457 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006458 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006459 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
6460 }
6461 }
6462
6463 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6464 //
6465 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6466 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6467 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6468 //
6469 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6470 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6471 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6472 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6473 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6474 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6475 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6476 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6477 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6478 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006479 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006480 continue;
6481
6482 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
6483 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6484 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
6485 }
6486 }
6487
6488 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6489 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6490 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6491 //
6492 // T& operator*(T*);
6493 //
6494 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006495 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006496 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006497 // T& operator*(T*);
6498 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6499 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6500 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6501 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6502 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6503 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6504 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006505 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6506 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006507
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006508 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6509 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6510 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006511
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006512 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
6513 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6514 }
6515 }
6516
6517 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6518 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6519 // operator functions of the form
6520 //
6521 // T operator+(T);
6522 // T operator-(T);
6523 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006524 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6525 return;
6526
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006527 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6528 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006529 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006530 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6531 }
6532
6533 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6534 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6535 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6536 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6537 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6538 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6539 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6540 }
6541 }
6542
6543 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6544 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6545 // the form
6546 //
6547 // T* operator+(T*);
6548 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6549 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6550 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6551 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6552 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6553 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6554 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6555 }
6556 }
6557
6558 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6559 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6560 // operator functions of the form
6561 //
6562 // T operator~(T);
6563 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006564 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6565 return;
6566
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006567 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6568 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006569 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006570 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6571 }
6572
6573 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6574 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6575 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6576 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6577 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6578 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6579 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6580 }
6581 }
6582
6583 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6584 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6585 // functions of the form
6586 //
6587 // bool operator==(T,T);
6588 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6589 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6590 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6591 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6592
6593 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6594 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6595 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6596 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6597 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6598 ++MemPtr) {
6599 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6600 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6601 continue;
6602
6603 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6604 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6605 CandidateSet);
6606 }
6607 }
6608 }
6609
6610 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6611 //
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006612 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6613 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006614 //
6615 // bool operator<(T, T);
6616 // bool operator>(T, T);
6617 // bool operator<=(T, T);
6618 // bool operator>=(T, T);
6619 // bool operator==(T, T);
6620 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006621 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
6622 // C++ [over.built]p1:
6623 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
6624 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
6625 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
6626 // functions.
6627 //
6628 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
6629 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
6630 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
6631 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
6632 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
6633 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
6634 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
6635 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
6636 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
6637
6638 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6639 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
6640 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
6641 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
6642 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6643 C != CEnd; ++C) {
6644 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
6645 continue;
6646
6647 QualType FirstParamType =
6648 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6649 QualType SecondParamType =
6650 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6651
6652 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
6653 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
6654 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
6655 continue;
6656
6657 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
6658 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
6659 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
6660 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
6661 }
6662 }
6663 }
6664
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006665 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6666 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6667
6668 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6669 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6670 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6671 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6672 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6673 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6674 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6675 continue;
6676
6677 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6678 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6679 CandidateSet);
6680 }
6681 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6682 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6683 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6684 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6685 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
6686
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006687 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
6688 // candidate exists.
6689 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
6690 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
6691 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006692 continue;
6693
6694 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006695 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6696 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006697 }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006698
6699 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
6700 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
6701 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
6702 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
6703 NullPtrTy))) {
6704 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
6705 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6706 CandidateSet);
6707 }
6708 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006709 }
6710 }
6711
6712 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6713 //
6714 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
6715 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6716 //
6717 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6718 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
6719 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6720 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6721 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
6722 //
6723 // C++ [over.built]p14:
6724 //
6725 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
6726 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6727 //
6728 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6729 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6730 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6731 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6732
6733 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
6734 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
6735 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6736 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6737 };
6738 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6739 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
6740 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
6741 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006742 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6743 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
6744 continue;
6745
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006746 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
6747 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
6748 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
6749 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6750 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
6751 CandidateSet);
6752 }
6753 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
6754 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6755 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6756 continue;
6757
6758 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6759 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
6760 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6761 }
6762 }
6763 }
6764 }
6765
6766 // C++ [over.built]p12:
6767 //
6768 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
6769 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6770 //
6771 // LR operator*(L, R);
6772 // LR operator/(L, R);
6773 // LR operator+(L, R);
6774 // LR operator-(L, R);
6775 // bool operator<(L, R);
6776 // bool operator>(L, R);
6777 // bool operator<=(L, R);
6778 // bool operator>=(L, R);
6779 // bool operator==(L, R);
6780 // bool operator!=(L, R);
6781 //
6782 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6783 // between types L and R.
6784 //
6785 // C++ [over.built]p24:
6786 //
6787 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
6788 // candidate operator functions of the form
6789 //
6790 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
6791 //
6792 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6793 // between types L and R.
6794 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
6795 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006796 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6797 return;
6798
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006799 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6800 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
6801 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6802 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006803 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6804 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006805 QualType Result =
6806 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006807 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006808 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6809 }
6810 }
6811
6812 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
6813 // conditional operator for vector types.
6814 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6815 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6816 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6817 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
6818 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6819 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
6820 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
6821 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
6822 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
6823 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
6824 if (!isComparison) {
6825 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
6826 Result = *Vec1;
6827 else
6828 Result = *Vec2;
6829 }
6830
6831 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6832 }
6833 }
6834 }
6835
6836 // C++ [over.built]p17:
6837 //
6838 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
6839 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6840 //
6841 // LR operator%(L, R);
6842 // LR operator&(L, R);
6843 // LR operator^(L, R);
6844 // LR operator|(L, R);
6845 // L operator<<(L, R);
6846 // L operator>>(L, R);
6847 //
6848 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6849 // between types L and R.
6850 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006851 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6852 return;
6853
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006854 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6855 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
6856 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6857 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006858 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6859 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006860 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
6861 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006862 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006863 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6864 }
6865 }
6866 }
6867
6868 // C++ [over.built]p20:
6869 //
6870 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
6871 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
6872 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6873 //
6874 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
6875 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
6876 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6877 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6878
6879 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
6880 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6881 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6882 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6883 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6884 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
6885 continue;
6886
6887 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
6888 CandidateSet);
6889 }
6890
6891 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6892 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6893 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6894 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6895 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6896 continue;
6897
6898 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
6899 CandidateSet);
6900 }
6901 }
6902 }
6903
6904 // C++ [over.built]p19:
6905 //
6906 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
6907 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
6908 // of the form
6909 //
6910 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
6911 //
6912 // C++ [over.built]p21:
6913 //
6914 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6915 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
6916 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6917 //
6918 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
6919 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
6920 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
6921 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6922 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6923
6924 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6925 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6926 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6927 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6928 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
6929 if (isEqualOp)
6930 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006931 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
6932 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006933
6934 // non-volatile version
6935 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6936 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
6937 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6938 };
6939 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6940 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
6941
6942 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6943 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6944 // volatile version
6945 ParamTypes[0] =
6946 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
6947 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6948 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6949 }
6950 }
6951
6952 if (isEqualOp) {
6953 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6954 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
6955 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
6956 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6957 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
6958 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6959 continue;
6960
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006961 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6962 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
6963 *Ptr,
6964 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006965
6966 // non-volatile version
6967 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6968 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
6969
6970 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6971 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6972 // volatile version
6973 ParamTypes[0] =
6974 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006975 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6976 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006977 }
6978 }
6979 }
6980 }
6981
6982 // C++ [over.built]p18:
6983 //
6984 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
6985 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
6986 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
6987 // the form
6988 //
6989 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
6990 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
6991 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
6992 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
6993 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
6994 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006995 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6996 return;
6997
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006998 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
6999 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7000 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7001 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007002 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007003
7004 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7005 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007006 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007007 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7008 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7009
7010 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7011 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7012 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007013 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007014 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007015 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7016 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007017 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7018 }
7019 }
7020 }
7021
7022 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7023 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7024 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7025 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7026 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7027 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7028 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7029 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7030 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7031 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7032 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7033 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7034 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7035 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7036 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7037
7038 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7039 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7040 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7041 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007042 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7043 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007044 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7045 }
7046 }
7047 }
7048 }
7049
7050 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7051 //
7052 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7053 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7054 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7055 //
7056 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7057 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7058 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7059 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7060 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7061 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7062 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007063 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7064 return;
7065
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007066 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7067 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7068 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7069 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007070 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007071
7072 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7073 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007074 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007075 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7076 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7077 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007078 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007079 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7080 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7081 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7082 CandidateSet);
7083 }
7084 }
7085 }
7086 }
7087
7088 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7089 //
7090 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7091 //
7092 // bool operator!(bool);
7093 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7094 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7095 void addExclaimOverload() {
7096 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
7097 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
7098 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7099 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7100 }
7101 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7102 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
7103 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7104 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7105 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7106 }
7107
7108 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7109 //
7110 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7111 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7112 //
7113 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7114 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7115 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7116 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7117 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7118 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7119 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7120 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7121 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7122 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7123 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7124 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007125 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7126 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007127
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007128 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7129
7130 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
7131 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7132 }
7133
7134 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7135 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7136 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7137 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7138 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7139 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007140 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7141 continue;
7142
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007143 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7144
7145 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
7146 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7147 }
7148 }
7149
7150 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7151 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7152 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7153 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7154 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7155 //
7156 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7157 //
7158 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7159 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7160 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7161 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7162 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7163 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7164 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7165 QualType C1;
7166 QualifierCollector Q1;
7167 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7168 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7169 continue;
7170 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7171 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7172 // volatile/restrict type.
7173 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7174 continue;
7175 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7176 continue;
7177 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7178 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7179 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7180 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7181 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7182 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7183 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7184 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7185 break;
7186 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7187 // build CV12 T&
7188 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7189 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7190 T.isVolatileQualified())
7191 continue;
7192 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7193 T.isRestrictQualified())
7194 continue;
7195 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7196 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7197 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7198 }
7199 }
7200 }
7201
7202 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7203 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7204 // therefore added as binary.
7205 //
7206 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7207 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7208 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7209 //
7210 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7211 //
7212 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7213 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7214 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7215
7216 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7217 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7218 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7219 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7220 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7221 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7222 continue;
7223
7224 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7225 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7226 }
7227
7228 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7229 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7230 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7231 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7232 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7233 continue;
7234
7235 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7236 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7237 }
7238
7239 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
7240 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7241 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7242 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7243 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7244 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7245 continue;
7246
7247 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7248 continue;
7249
7250 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7251 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7252 }
7253 }
7254 }
7255 }
7256};
7257
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007258} // end anonymous namespace
7259
7260/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7261/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7262/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7263/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7264/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7265void
7266Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7267 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7268 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7269 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007270 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7271 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007272 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7273 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007274 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7275 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007276 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7277 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007278
7279 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7280 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007281 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007282 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7283 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7284 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7285 OpLoc,
7286 true,
7287 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7288 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7289 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7290 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007291 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7292 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7293 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7294 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7295 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007296 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007297
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007298 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7299 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor877d4eb2011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007300 //
7301 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7302 // 'bool' overloads.
7303 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7304 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007305 return;
7306
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007307 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7308 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
7309 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007310 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007311 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7312
7313 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007314 switch (Op) {
7315 case OO_None:
7316 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007317 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007318
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007319 case OO_New:
7320 case OO_Delete:
7321 case OO_Array_New:
7322 case OO_Array_Delete:
7323 case OO_Call:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007324 llvm_unreachable(
7325 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007326
7327 case OO_Comma:
7328 case OO_Arrow:
7329 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7330 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7331 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007332 break;
7333
7334 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007335 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007336 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007337 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007338
7339 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007340 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007341 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007342 } else {
7343 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7344 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7345 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007346 break;
7347
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007348 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007349 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007350 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7351 else
7352 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7353 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007354
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007355 case OO_Slash:
7356 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007357 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007358
7359 case OO_PlusPlus:
7360 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007361 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7362 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007363 break;
7364
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007365 case OO_EqualEqual:
7366 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007367 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007368 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007369
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007370 case OO_Less:
7371 case OO_Greater:
7372 case OO_LessEqual:
7373 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007374 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007375 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7376 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007377
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007378 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007379 case OO_Caret:
7380 case OO_Pipe:
7381 case OO_LessLess:
7382 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007383 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007384 break;
7385
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007386 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
7387 if (NumArgs == 1)
7388 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7389 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7390 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7391 break;
7392
7393 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7394 break;
7395
7396 case OO_Tilde:
7397 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7398 break;
7399
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007400 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007401 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007402 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007403
7404 case OO_PlusEqual:
7405 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007406 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007407 // Fall through.
7408
7409 case OO_StarEqual:
7410 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007411 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007412 break;
7413
7414 case OO_PercentEqual:
7415 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7416 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7417 case OO_AmpEqual:
7418 case OO_CaretEqual:
7419 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007420 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007421 break;
7422
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007423 case OO_Exclaim:
7424 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007425 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007426
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007427 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007428 case OO_PipePipe:
7429 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007430 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007431
7432 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007433 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007434 break;
7435
7436 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007437 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007438 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007439
7440 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007441 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007442 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7443 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007444 }
7445}
7446
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007447/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7448/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7449///
7450/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7451/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7452/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7453/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007454void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007455Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithe06a2c12012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007456 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007457 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007458 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007459 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007460 bool PartialOverloading,
7461 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007462 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007463
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007464 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7465 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7466 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7467 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7468 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7469 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7470
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007471 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007472 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007473 StdNamespaceIsAssociated);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007474
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007475 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007476 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7477 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7478 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007479 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007480 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007481 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007482 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007483 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007484
7485 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7486 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007487 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007488 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007489 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007490 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007491 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007492
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007493 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
7494 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007495 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007496 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007497 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007498 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007499 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007500}
7501
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007502/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7503/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007504bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007505isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007506 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7507 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007508 SourceLocation Loc,
7509 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007510 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7511 // functions.
7512 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7513 return Cand1.Viable;
7514 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7515 return false;
7516
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007517 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7518 //
7519 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7520 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7521 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7522 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7523 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7524 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7525 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007526
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007527 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007528 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7529 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007530 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007531 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7532 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007533 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007534 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007535 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7536 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007537 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7538 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7539 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7540 HasBetterConversion = true;
7541 break;
7542
7543 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7544 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7545 return false;
7546
7547 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7548 // Do nothing.
7549 break;
7550 }
7551 }
7552
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007553 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007554 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007555 if (HasBetterConversion)
7556 return true;
7557
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007558 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007559 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007560 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007561 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7562 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007563
7564 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7565 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7566 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007567 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007568 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007569 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007570 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007571 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7572 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7573 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007574 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregorb837ea42011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007575 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007576 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007577 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007578 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007579
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007580 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
7581 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
7582 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
7583 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
7584 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
7585 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007586 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007587 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007588 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00007589 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
7590 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
7591 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
7592 // pointer or block.
7593 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
7594 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
7595 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
7596 return FuncResult;
7597
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007598 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
7599 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007600 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
7601 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7602 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7603 return true;
7604
7605 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7606 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7607 return false;
7608
7609 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7610 // Do nothing
7611 break;
7612 }
7613 }
7614
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007615 return false;
7616}
7617
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007618/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007619/// within an overload candidate set.
7620///
7621/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
7622///
7623/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
7624/// which overload resolution occurs.
7625///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007626/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007627/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
7628///
7629/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007630OverloadingResult
7631OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007632 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007633 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007634 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007635 Best = end();
7636 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
7637 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007638 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007639 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007640 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007641 }
7642
7643 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007644 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007645 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
7646
7647 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
7648 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007649 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007650 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007651 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007652 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007653 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007654 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007655 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007656 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007657 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007658
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007659 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007660 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007661 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
7662 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007663 return OR_Deleted;
7664
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007665 return OR_Success;
7666}
7667
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007668namespace {
7669
7670enum OverloadCandidateKind {
7671 oc_function,
7672 oc_method,
7673 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007674 oc_function_template,
7675 oc_method_template,
7676 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007677 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
7678 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007679 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007680 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007681 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007682 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007683};
7684
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007685OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
7686 FunctionDecl *Fn,
7687 std::string &Description) {
7688 bool isTemplate = false;
7689
7690 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
7691 isTemplate = true;
7692 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7693 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
7694 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007695
7696 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007697 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007698 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007699
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007700 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
7701 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
7702
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007703 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
7704 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
7705
7706 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
7707 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
7708
7709 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
7710 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
7711 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007712 }
7713
7714 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7715 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
7716 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007717 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007718 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007719
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007720 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
7721 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
7722
Douglas Gregor12695102012-02-10 08:36:38 +00007723 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
7724 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
7725
7726 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
7727 return oc_method;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007728 }
7729
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007730 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007731}
7732
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007733void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
7734 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
7735 if (!Ctor) return;
7736
7737 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
7738 if (!Ctor) return;
7739
7740 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
7741}
7742
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007743} // end anonymous namespace
7744
7745// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007746void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007747 std::string FnDesc;
7748 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007749 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7750 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
7751 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
7752 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007753 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007754}
7755
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007756//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
7757// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007758void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007759 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7760
7761 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
7762 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
7763
7764 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7765 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7766 I != IEnd; ++I) {
7767 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
7768 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007769 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007770 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
7771 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007772 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007773 }
7774 }
7775}
7776
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007777/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
7778/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
7779/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007780void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
7781 Sema &S,
7782 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7783 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
7784 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
7785 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007786 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007787 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7788 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007789 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007790}
7791
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007792namespace {
7793
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007794void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
7795 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
7796 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007797 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
7798 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7799
7800 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
7801 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
7802 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007803 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007804 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007805 if (I == 0)
7806 isObjectArgument = true;
7807 else
7808 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007809 }
7810
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007811 std::string FnDesc;
7812 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
7813
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007814 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
7815 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
7816 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007817
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007818 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007819 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007820 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
7821 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
7822 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007823 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007824
7825 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
7826 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7827 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7828 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007829 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007830 return;
7831 }
7832
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007833 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
7834 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007835 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
7836 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
7837 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7838 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
7839 else {
7840 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
7841 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7842 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7843 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
7844 }
7845
7846 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
7847 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
7848 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
7849 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
7850 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
7851 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
7852 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
7853
7854 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7855 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7856
7857 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
7858 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
7859 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7860 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7861 << FromTy
7862 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
7863 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007864 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007865 return;
7866 }
7867
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007868 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscff00d92011-06-24 00:08:59 +00007869 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007870 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7871 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7872 << FromTy
7873 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
7874 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7875 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7876 return;
7877 }
7878
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00007879 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
7880 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
7881 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7882 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7883 << FromTy
7884 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
7885 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7886 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7887 return;
7888 }
7889
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007890 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
7891 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
7892
7893 if (isObjectArgument) {
7894 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
7895 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7896 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7897 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
7898 } else {
7899 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
7900 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7901 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7902 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
7903 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007904 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007905 return;
7906 }
7907
Sebastian Redla72462c2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00007908 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
7909 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
7910 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
7911 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
7912 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7913 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7914 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7915 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7916 return;
7917 }
7918
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007919 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
7920 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
7921 // the failure.
7922 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
7923 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7924 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7925 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
7926 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
7927 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7928 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7929 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007930 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007931 return;
7932 }
7933
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007934 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007935 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007936 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7937 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7938 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
7939 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
7940 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7941 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007942 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007943 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007944 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007945 }
7946 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
7947 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
7948 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
7949 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
7950 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
7951 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
7952 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
7953 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
7954 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007955 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
7956 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
7957 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
7958 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
7959 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7960 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
7961 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
7962 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007963
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007964 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007965 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007966 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007967 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7968 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007969 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007970 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007971 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007972 return;
7973 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007974
Fariborz Jahaniana644f9c2011-07-20 17:14:09 +00007975 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
7976 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
7977 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7978 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7979 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
7980 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
7981 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7982 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7983 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7984 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7985 return;
7986 }
7987 }
7988
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007989 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
7990 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
7991 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007992 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007993 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
7994 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
7995
7996 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer490afa62012-01-14 21:05:10 +00007997 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
7998 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007999 FDiag << *HI;
8000 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8001
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008002 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008003}
8004
8005void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8006 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8007 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8008
8009 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8010 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8011
8012 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008013
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008014 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8015 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
8016 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8017 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8018 // Just don't report anything.
8019 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8020 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8021 return;
8022
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008023 // at least / at most / exactly
8024 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8025 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008026 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8027 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8028 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008029 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregor7825bf32011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008030 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008031 mode = 0; // "at least"
8032 else
8033 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8034 modeCount = MinParams;
8035 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008036 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8037 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8038 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008039 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8040 mode = 1; // "at most"
8041 else
8042 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8043 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8044 }
8045
8046 std::string Description;
8047 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8048
8049 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008050 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008051 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008052 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008053}
8054
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008055/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8056void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008057 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008058 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
8059
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008060 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008061 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8062 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8063 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8064 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008065 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
8066 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8067 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8068
8069 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008070 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8071 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8072 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008073 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008074 return;
8075 }
8076
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008077 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8078 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8079 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8080
8081 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8082
8083 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8084 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008085 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008086 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008087 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008088 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8089
8090 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8091 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8092 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8093 // done on dependent types).
8094 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8095
8096 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8097 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008098 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008099 return;
8100 }
8101
8102 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008103 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008104 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008105 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008106 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008107 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008108 which = 1;
8109 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008110 which = 2;
8111 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008112
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008113 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008114 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008115 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8116 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008117 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008118 return;
8119 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008120
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008121 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008122 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008123 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008124 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008125 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8126 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8127 else {
8128 int index = 0;
8129 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8130 index = TTP->getIndex();
8131 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8132 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8133 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8134 else
8135 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008136 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008137 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8138 << (index + 1);
8139 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008140 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008141 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008142
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008143 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8144 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8145 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
8146 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008147
8148 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8149 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008150 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008151 return;
8152
8153 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
8154 std::string ArgString;
8155 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
8156 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
8157 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8158 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
8159 *Args);
8160 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
8161 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008162 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008163 return;
8164 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008165
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008166 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8167 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008168 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008169 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8170 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008171 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008172 return;
8173 }
8174}
8175
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008176/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8177void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8178 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8179 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8180
8181 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8182 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8183
8184 std::string FnDesc;
8185 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8186
8187 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8188 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8189}
8190
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008191/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8192/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8193///
8194/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8195/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8196/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8197/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8198/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8199/// overload.
8200///
8201/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8202/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8203/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008204void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008205 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008206 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8207
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008208 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008209 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8210 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008211 std::string FnDesc;
8212 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008213
8214 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008215 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008216 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008217 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008218 }
8219
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008220 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8221 if (Cand->Viable) {
8222 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8223 return;
8224 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008225
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008226 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8227 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8228 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8229 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008230
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008231 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008232 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008233
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008234 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8235 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008236 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008237 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008238
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008239 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8240 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008241 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008242 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8243 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008244
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008245 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8246 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8247 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8248 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008249 }
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008250
8251 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8252 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008253 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008254}
8255
8256void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8257 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8258 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8259 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8260 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8261 bool isLValueReference = false;
8262 bool isRValueReference = false;
8263 bool isPointer = false;
8264 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8265 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8266 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8267 isLValueReference = true;
8268 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8269 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8270 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8271 isRValueReference = true;
8272 }
8273 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8274 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8275 isPointer = true;
8276 }
8277 // Desugar down to a function type.
8278 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8279 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8280 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8281 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8282 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8283
8284 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8285 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008286 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008287}
8288
8289void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
8290 const char *Opc,
8291 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8292 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008293 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008294 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8295 TypeStr += Opc;
8296 TypeStr += "(";
8297 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008298 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008299 TypeStr += ")";
8300 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8301 } else {
8302 TypeStr += ", ";
8303 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8304 TypeStr += ")";
8305 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8306 }
8307}
8308
8309void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8310 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008311 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008312 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8313 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008314 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8315 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8316
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008317 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008318 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008319 }
8320}
8321
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008322SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8323 if (Cand->Function)
8324 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008325 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008326 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8327 return SourceLocation();
8328}
8329
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008330static unsigned
8331RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth73fddfe2011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008332 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008333 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008334 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008335
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008336 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8337 return 1;
8338
8339 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8340 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8341 return 2;
8342
8343 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8344 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
8345 return 3;
8346
8347 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8348 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8349 return 4;
8350
8351 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8352 return 5;
8353
8354 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8355 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8356 return 6;
8357 }
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008358 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008359}
8360
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008361struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8362 Sema &S;
8363 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008364
8365 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8366 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008367 // Fast-path this check.
8368 if (L == R) return false;
8369
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008370 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008371 if (L->Viable) {
8372 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8373
8374 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8375 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8376 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008377 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8378 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008379 } else if (R->Viable)
8380 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008381
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008382 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008383
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008384 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8385 if (!L->Viable) {
8386 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8387 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8388 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8389 return false;
8390 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8391 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8392 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008393
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008394 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8395 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8396 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8397 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8398 return true;
8399
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008400 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8401 // comes first.
8402 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8403 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8404 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8405 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008406 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008407 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8408 return true;
8409 else
8410 return false;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008411 }
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008412
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008413 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8414 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008415 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008416
8417 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008418 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008419 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008420 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8421 L->Conversions[I],
8422 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008423 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8424 leftBetter++;
8425 break;
8426
8427 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8428 leftBetter--;
8429 break;
8430
8431 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8432 break;
8433 }
8434 }
8435 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8436 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8437
8438 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8439 return false;
8440
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008441 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8442 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8443 return true;
8444
8445 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8446 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedman1e7a0c62011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008447 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedmane2c600c2011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008448 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8449 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008450
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008451 // TODO: others?
8452 }
8453
8454 // Sort everything else by location.
8455 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8456 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8457
8458 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8459 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8460 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8461
8462 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008463 }
8464};
8465
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008466/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008467/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008468void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008469 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008470 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8471
8472 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8473 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8474
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008475 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8476 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008477 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8478 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008479
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008480 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008481 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008482 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008483 while (true) {
8484 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8485 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008486 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008487 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008488 break;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008489 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008490 }
8491
8492 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8493 return;
8494
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008495 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8496 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8497
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008498 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008499 // operation somehow.
8500 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008501
8502 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
8503 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
8504
8505 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
8506 QualType ConvType
8507 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8508 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8509 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
8510 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8511 ArgIdx--;
8512 } else if (Cand->Function) {
8513 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8514 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
8515 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
8516 ArgIdx--;
8517 } else {
8518 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
8519 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
8520 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
8521 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008522 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
8523 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008524 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008525 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
8526 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
8527 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008528 return;
8529 }
8530
8531 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
8532 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8533 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008534 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008535 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008536 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008537 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008538 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
8539 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
8540 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008541 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
8542 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008543 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008544 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008545 else
8546 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
8547 }
8548}
8549
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008550} // end anonymous namespace
8551
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008552/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
8553/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008554/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008555void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
8556 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008557 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008558 const char *Opc,
8559 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008560 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
8561 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008562 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008563 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
8564 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008565 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008566 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008567 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008568 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008569 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
8570 Cands.push_back(Cand);
8571 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
8572 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008573 }
8574 }
8575
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008576 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008577 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008578
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008579 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008580
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008581 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00008582 const DiagnosticsEngine::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads =
8583 S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008584 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008585 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8586 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00008587
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008588 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
8589 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
8590 // candidate list.
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00008591 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == DiagnosticsEngine::Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008592 break;
8593 }
8594 ++CandsShown;
8595
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008596 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008597 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008598 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008599 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008600 else {
8601 assert(Cand->Viable &&
8602 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008603 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
8604 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
8605 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
8606 //
8607 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
8608 // different ambiguities, though.
8609 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008610 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008611 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
8612 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008613
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008614 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008615 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008616 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008617 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008618
8619 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008620 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008621}
8622
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008623// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
8624// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
8625// R (A) --> R(A)
8626// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
8627// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
8628// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
8629QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
8630 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
8631 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
8632 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
8633 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8634 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
8635 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8636 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008637 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008638 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8639 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8640 Ret =
8641 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
8642 return Ret;
8643}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008644
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008645// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
8646// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
8647class AddressOfFunctionResolver
8648{
8649 Sema& S;
8650 Expr* SourceExpr;
8651 const QualType& TargetType;
8652 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
8653
8654 bool Complain;
8655 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
8656 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008657
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008658 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
8659 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008660
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008661 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
8662 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
8663 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008664 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008665
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008666public:
8667 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
8668 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
8669 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
8670 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
8671 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
8672 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
8673 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
8674 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
8675 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
8676 {
8677 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
8678
8679 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
8680 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8681 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008682 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008683 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00008684
8685 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8686 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
8687 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
8688 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
8689 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
8690 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
8691
8692 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
8693 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
8694 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
8695 return;
8696 }
8697 }
8698
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008699 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
8700 }
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00008701 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008702 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00008703 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008704
8705 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
8706 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008707
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008708 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
8709 // C++ [over.over]p4:
8710 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
8711 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
8712 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
8713 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
8714 else
8715 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
8716 }
8717 }
8718 }
8719
8720private:
8721 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
8722 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
8723 }
8724
8725 // [ToType] [Return]
8726
8727 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
8728 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
8729 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
8730 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
8731 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
8732 }
8733
8734 // return true if any matching specializations were found
8735 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
8736 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
8737 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
8738 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
8739 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
8740 // static when converting to member pointer.
8741 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8742 return false;
8743 }
8744 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8745 return false;
8746
8747 // C++ [over.over]p2:
8748 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
8749 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
8750 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
8751 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
8752 // overloaded functions considered.
8753 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
8754 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
8755 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
8756 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
8757 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
8758 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
8759 Info)) {
8760 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
8761 (void)Result;
8762 return false;
8763 }
8764
8765 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
8766 // This function template specicalization works.
8767 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
8768 assert(TargetFunctionType
8769 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
8770 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
8771 return true;
8772 }
8773
8774 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
8775 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00008776 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008777 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
8778 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008779 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8780 return false;
8781 }
8782 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8783 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008784
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00008785 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008786 if (S.getLangOptions().CUDA)
8787 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
8788 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
8789 return false;
8790
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00008791 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008792 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
8793 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00008794 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
8795 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008796 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
8797 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00008798 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008799 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00008800 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008801 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008802
8803 return false;
8804 }
8805
8806 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
8807 bool Ret = false;
8808
8809 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
8810 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
8811 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
8812 return false;
8813
8814 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8815 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8816 I != E; ++I) {
8817 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
8818 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
8819
8820 // C++ [over.over]p3:
8821 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
8822 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
8823 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
8824 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
8825 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
8826 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
8827 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
8828 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
8829 Ret = true;
8830 }
8831 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
8832 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
8833 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
8834 Ret = true;
8835 }
8836 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
8837 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008838 }
8839
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008840 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008841 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
8842 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
8843 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
8844 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
8845 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
8846
8847 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
8848 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
8849 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
8850 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008851
8852 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
8853 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
8854 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008855
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008856 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008857 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
8858 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
8859 S.PDiag(),
8860 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8861 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
8862 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8863 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008864 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008865
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008866 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
8867 // Make it the first and only element
8868 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
8869 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
8870 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008871 }
8872 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008873
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008874 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
8875 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
8876 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
8877 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
8878 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
8879 ++I;
8880 else {
8881 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
8882 Matches.set_size(N);
8883 }
8884 }
8885 }
8886
8887public:
8888 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
8889 assert(Matches.empty());
8890 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
8891 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
8892 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008893 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008894 }
8895
8896 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
8897 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
8898 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
8899 }
8900
8901 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
8902 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
8903 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
8904 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
8905 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
8906 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
8907 }
8908
8909 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
8910 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
8911 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
8912 }
8913
8914 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
8915 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
8916 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8917 << OvlExpr->getName()
8918 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008919 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008920 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008921
8922 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
8923
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008924 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
8925
8926 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
8927 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
8928 return Matches[0].second;
8929 }
8930
8931 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
8932 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
8933 return &Matches[0].first;
8934 }
8935};
8936
8937/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
8938/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
8939/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
8940/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
8941///
8942/// @code
8943/// int f(double);
8944/// int f(int);
8945///
8946/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
8947/// @endcode
8948///
8949/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
8950/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
8951/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
8952FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008953Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
8954 QualType TargetType,
8955 bool Complain,
8956 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
8957 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008958 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008959
8960 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
8961 Complain);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008962 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
8963 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008964 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008965 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
8966 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
8967 else
8968 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
8969 }
8970 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
8971 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
8972 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
8973 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
8974 assert(Fn);
8975 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00008976 MarkFunctionReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00008977 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008978 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00008979 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008980
8981 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
8982 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008983 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008984}
8985
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008986/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008987/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
8988///
8989/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
8990/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008991/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008992/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008993FunctionDecl *
8994Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
8995 bool Complain,
8996 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008997 // C++ [over.over]p1:
8998 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
8999 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009000 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9001 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
9002 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009003
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009004 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009005 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009006 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009007
9008 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009009 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009010
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009011 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9012 // whose type matches exactly.
9013 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009014 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9015 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009016 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9017 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009018 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9019 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9020 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009021 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009022 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9023 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009024
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009025 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9026 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9027 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9028 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9029 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9030 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009031 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009032 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009033 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9034 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9035 Specialization, Info)) {
9036 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9037 (void)Result;
9038 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009039 }
9040
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009041 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9042
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009043 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009044 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009045 if (Complain) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009046 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9047 << ovl->getName();
9048 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009049 }
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009050 return 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009051 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009052
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009053 Matched = Specialization;
9054 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009055 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009056
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009057 return Matched;
9058}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009059
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009060
9061
9062
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009063// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9064// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9065//
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009066// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009067//
9068// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9069// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9070// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9071bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9072 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9073 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009074 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009075 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009076 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009077
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009078 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009079
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009080 DeclAccessPair found;
9081 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9082 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9083 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009084 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin())) {
9085 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9086 return true;
9087 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009088
9089 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9090 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9091 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9092 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9093 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9094 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9095 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009096 if (!complain) return false;
9097
9098 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9099 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9100 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9101
9102 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9103 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9104 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9105 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9106 // the static candidates were rejected.
9107 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9108 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009109 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009110
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009111 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'.
9112 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009113 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009114
9115 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009116 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009117 SingleFunctionExpression =
9118 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009119 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9120 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9121 return true;
9122 }
9123 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009124 }
9125
9126 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9127 if (complain) {
9128 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9129 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9130 << DestTypeForComplaining
9131 << OpRangeForComplaining
9132 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009133 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9134
9135 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9136 return true;
9137 }
9138
9139 return false;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009140 }
9141
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009142 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9143 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009144}
9145
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009146/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9147static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009148 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009149 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009150 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009151 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009152 bool PartialOverloading,
9153 bool KnownValid) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009154 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009155 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9156 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9157
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009158 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009159 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9160 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9161 return;
9162 }
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009163 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
9164 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009165 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009166 }
9167
9168 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9169 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009170 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009171 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009172 return;
9173 }
9174
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009175 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009176}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009177
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009178/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9179/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009180void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009181 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009182 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9183 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009184
9185#ifndef NDEBUG
9186 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9187 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009188 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009189 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9190 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9191 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9192 //
9193 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9194 //
9195 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009196 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009197 //
9198 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9199 // template
9200 //
9201 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009202
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009203 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9204 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9205 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9206 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9207 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9208 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9209 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009210 }
9211 }
9212#endif
9213
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009214 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9215 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009216 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009217 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9218 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9219 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9220 }
9221
9222 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9223 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009224 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
9225 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
9226 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009227
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009228 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009229 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithe06a2c12012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009230 ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009231 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9232 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00009233 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace());
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009234}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009235
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009236/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9237/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9238/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9239/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9240///
9241/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9242static bool
9243DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9244 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9245 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009246 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009247 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9248 return false;
9249
9250 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
9251 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9252
9253 if (!R.empty()) {
9254 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9255
9256 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9257 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9258 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9259 R.clear();
9260 return false;
9261 }
9262
9263 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9264 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9265 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009266 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009267 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009268
9269 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009270 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009271 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9272 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009273 R.clear();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009274 return false;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009275 }
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009276
9277 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9278 // declaring the function there instead.
9279 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9280 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009281 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(Args,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009282 AssociatedNamespaces,
9283 AssociatedClasses);
9284 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009285 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009286 if (DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009287 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9288 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009289 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
9290 if (!Std->Encloses(*it))
9291 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
9292 }
Chandler Carruthd54186a2011-06-08 10:13:17 +00009293 } else {
9294 // Lacking the 'std::' namespace, use all of the associated namespaces.
9295 SuggestedNamespaces = AssociatedNamespaces;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009296 }
9297
9298 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9299 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009300 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009301 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9302 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9303 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009304 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009305 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9306 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009307 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009308 } else {
9309 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9310 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9311 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9312 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9313 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9314 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9315 }
9316
9317 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9318 return true;
9319 }
9320
9321 R.clear();
9322 }
9323
9324 return false;
9325}
9326
9327/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9328/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9329/// was defined.
9330///
9331/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9332static bool
9333DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9334 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009335 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009336 DeclarationName OpName =
9337 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9338 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9339 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009340 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009341}
9342
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009343namespace {
9344// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9345// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9346// that accept the given number of arguments.
9347class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9348 public:
9349 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9350 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9351 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus;
9352 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9353 }
9354
9355 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9356 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9357 return candidate.isKeyword();
9358
9359 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9360 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9361 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9362 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9363 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9364 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9365 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9366 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9367 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9368 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9369 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9370 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9371 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9372 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9373 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9374 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9375 return true;
9376 }
9377 }
9378 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9379 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9380 return true;
9381 }
9382 return false;
9383 }
9384
9385 private:
9386 unsigned NumArgs;
9387 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9388};
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009389
9390// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9391class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9392 public:
9393 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9394 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9395 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9396 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9397 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9398 }
9399
9400 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9401 return false;
9402 }
9403};
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009404}
9405
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009406/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9407///
9408/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009409static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009410BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009411 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9412 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009413 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009414 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009415 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009416
9417 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009418 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009419 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009420
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009421 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009422 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009423 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9424 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9425 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9426 }
9427
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009428 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9429 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009430 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009431 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9432 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9433 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9434 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009435 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009436 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009437 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009438 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009439 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009440 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009441
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009442 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
9443
9444 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
9445 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009446 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009447 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009448 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
9449 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara65f7c3d2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009450 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009451 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara65f7c3d2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009452 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009453 else
9454 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
9455
9456 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009457 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009458
9459 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009460 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009461 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009462 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009463 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
9464 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009465}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00009466
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009467/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00009468/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
9469/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
9470/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
9471/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00009472/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009473/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009474ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009475Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009476 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9477 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00009478 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009479 Expr *ExecConfig,
9480 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009481#ifndef NDEBUG
9482 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9483 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
9484 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
9485
9486 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
9487 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
9488 FunctionDecl *F;
9489 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
9490 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
9491 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009492 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009493
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009494 // We don't perform ADL in C.
9495 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00009496 } else
9497 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() &&
9498 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL");
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009499#endif
9500
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009501 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
9502 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
9503 return ExprError();
9504
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009505 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00009506
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009507 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
9508 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009509 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
9510 CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009511
9512 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009513 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
9514 // out if it fails.
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009515 if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009516 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
9517 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009518 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009519 // classes.
Francois Pichetf707ae62011-11-11 00:12:11 +00009520 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetde232cb2011-11-25 01:10:54 +00009521 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009522 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
9523 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
9524 RParenLoc);
9525 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
9526 return Owned(CE);
9527 }
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009528 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
9529 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009530 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
9531 AllowTypoCorrection);
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009532 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009533
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009534 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
9535
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009536 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009537 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009538 case OR_Success: {
9539 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00009540 MarkFunctionReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009541 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009542 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009543 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00009544 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
9545 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009546 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009547
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009548 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9549 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
9550 // have meant to call.
9551 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009552 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9553 RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009554 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
9555 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009556 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
9557 return Recovery;
9558
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00009559 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009560 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009561 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009562 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
9563 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009564 break;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009565 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009566
9567 case OR_Ambiguous:
9568 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009569 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009570 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
9571 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009572 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009573
9574 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00009575 {
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009576 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
9577 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9578 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009579 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009580 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009581 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
9582 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3eaa22a2011-11-04 15:58:13 +00009583
9584 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
9585 // the call in the AST.
9586 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
9587 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9588 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9589 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00009590 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009591 }
9592
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009593 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009594 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009595}
9596
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009597static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00009598 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
9599 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
9600}
9601
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009602/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
9603/// operator.
9604///
9605/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
9606///
9607/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
9608/// operator.
9609///
9610/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
9611/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
9612/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
9613/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
9614/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
9615/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
9616///
9617/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009618ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009619Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
9620 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009621 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009622 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009623
9624 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
9625 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
9626 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009627 // TODO: provide better source location info.
9628 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009629
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009630 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
9631 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009632
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009633 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
9634 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009635
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009636 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
9637 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
9638 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009639 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009640 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00009641 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
9642 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009643 NumArgs = 2;
9644 }
9645
9646 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009647 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009648 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009649 Opc,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009650 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009651 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009652 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009653
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009654 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009655 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00009656 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009657 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00009658 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
9659 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009660 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009661 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009662 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009663 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009664 OpLoc));
9665 }
9666
9667 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009668 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009669
9670 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009671 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
9672 false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009673
9674 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9675 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
9676
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009677 // Add candidates from ADL.
9678 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009679 OpLoc, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009680 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
9681 CandidateSet);
9682
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009683 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00009684 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009685
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009686 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9687
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009688 // Perform overload resolution.
9689 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009690 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009691 case OR_Success: {
9692 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9693 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009694
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009695 if (FnDecl) {
9696 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9697 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009698
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00009699 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009700
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009701 // Convert the arguments.
9702 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009703 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009704
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009705 ExprResult InputRes =
9706 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
9707 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9708 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009709 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009710 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009711 } else {
9712 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009713 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00009714 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009715 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00009716 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009717 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009718 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00009719 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009720 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009721 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009722 }
9723
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009724 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
9725
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009726 // Determine the result type.
9727 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9728 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9729 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009730
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009731 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009732 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +00009733 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009734 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9735 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009736
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00009737 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009738 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009739 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009740 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009741
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009742 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00009743 FnDecl))
9744 return ExprError();
9745
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009746 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009747 } else {
9748 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9749 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9750 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009751 ExprResult InputRes =
9752 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9753 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9754 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
9755 return ExprError();
9756 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009757 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009758 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009759 }
9760
9761 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009762 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
9763 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
9764 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009765 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc,
9766 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)))
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009767 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
9768 return ExprError();
9769
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009770 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
9771 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
9772 break;
9773
9774 case OR_Ambiguous:
9775 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
9776 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9777 << Input->getType()
9778 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009779 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
9780 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009781 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
9782 return ExprError();
9783
9784 case OR_Deleted:
9785 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9786 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9787 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9788 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
9789 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009790 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
9791 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00009792 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009793 return ExprError();
9794 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009795
9796 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
9797 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
9798 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009799 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009800}
9801
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009802/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
9803/// operator.
9804///
9805/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
9806///
9807/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
9808/// operator.
9809///
9810/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
9811/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
9812/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
9813/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
9814/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
9815/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
9816///
9817/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
9818/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009819ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009820Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009821 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009822 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009823 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009824 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009825 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009826
9827 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
9828 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
9829 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9830
9831 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
9832 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009833 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009834 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009835 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009836 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009837 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009838 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009839 Context.DependentTy,
9840 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9841 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009842
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009843 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
9844 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009845 VK_LValue,
9846 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009847 Context.DependentTy,
9848 Context.DependentTy,
9849 OpLoc));
9850 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009851
9852 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009853 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009854 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
9855 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009856 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009857 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
9858 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
9859 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00009860 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009861 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009862 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009863 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009864 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009865 OpLoc));
9866 }
9867
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009868 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
9869 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
9870 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009871
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00009872 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
9873 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
9874 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009875 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
9876 return ExprError();
9877
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00009878 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
9879 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
9880 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
9881 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
9882 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
9883 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009884 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009885 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009886
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009887 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
9888 // create a built-in binary operator.
9889 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
9890 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
9891
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009892 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009893 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009894
9895 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009896 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009897
9898 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9899 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9900
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009901 // Add candidates from ADL.
9902 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009903 OpLoc, Args,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009904 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
9905 CandidateSet);
9906
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009907 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00009908 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009909
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009910 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9911
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009912 // Perform overload resolution.
9913 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009914 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00009915 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009916 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9917 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
9918
9919 if (FnDecl) {
9920 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9921 // operator.
9922
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00009923 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009924
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009925 // Convert the arguments.
9926 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009927 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009928 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009929
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009930 ExprResult Arg1 =
9931 PerformCopyInitialization(
9932 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9933 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9934 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009935 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009936 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009937
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009938 ExprResult Arg0 =
9939 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
9940 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9941 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009942 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009943 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009944 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009945 } else {
9946 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009947 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
9948 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9949 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9950 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009951 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009952 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009953
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009954 ExprResult Arg1 =
9955 PerformCopyInitialization(
9956 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9957 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
9958 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009959 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
9960 return ExprError();
9961 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
9962 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009963 }
9964
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009965 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
9966
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009967 // Determine the result type.
9968 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9969 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9970 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009971
9972 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009973 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
9974 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009975 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9976 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009977
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009978 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009979 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009980 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009981
9982 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009983 FnDecl))
9984 return ExprError();
9985
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009986 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009987 } else {
9988 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9989 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9990 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009991 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
9992 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9993 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9994 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009995 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009996 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009997
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009998 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
9999 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10000 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10001 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10002 return ExprError();
10003 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010004 break;
10005 }
10006 }
10007
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010008 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10009 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
10010 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
10011 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
10012 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010013 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010014 break;
10015
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010016 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10017 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10018 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010019 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010020 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010021 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010022 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10023 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010024 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010025 } else {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010026 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10027 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10028 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010029 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010030 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10031 return ExprError();
10032
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010033 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10034 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10035 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010036 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010037 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010038 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10039 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010040 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010041 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010042 return move(Result);
10043 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010044
10045 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010046 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010047 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010048 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010049 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010050 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010051 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010052 return ExprError();
10053
10054 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregor74f7d502012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010055 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10056 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10057 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
10058 << getSpecialMember(Method)
10059 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10060 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function);
10061
10062 if (Method->getParent()->isLambda()) {
10063 Diag(Method->getParent()->getLocation(), diag::note_lambda_decl);
10064 return ExprError();
10065 }
10066 } else {
10067 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10068 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10069 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10070 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10071 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10072 }
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010073 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010074 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010075 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010076 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010077
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010078 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010079 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010080}
10081
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010082ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010083Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10084 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010085 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10086 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010087 DeclarationName OpName =
10088 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10089
10090 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10091 // expression.
10092 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10093
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010094 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010095 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10096 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10097 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010098 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010099 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010100 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010101 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10102 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10103 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010104 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010105
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010106 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
10107 Args, 2,
10108 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010109 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010110 RLoc));
10111 }
10112
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010113 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10114 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10115 return ExprError();
10116 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10117 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010118
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010119 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010120 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010121
10122 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10123
10124 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10125 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10126
10127 // Add builtin operator candidates.
10128 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10129
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010130 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10131
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010132 // Perform overload resolution.
10133 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010134 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010135 case OR_Success: {
10136 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10137 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10138
10139 if (FnDecl) {
10140 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10141 // operator.
10142
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010143 MarkFunctionReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +000010144
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010145 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010146 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010147
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010148 // Convert the arguments.
10149 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010150 ExprResult Arg0 =
10151 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10152 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10153 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010154 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010155 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010156
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010157 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010158 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010159 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010160 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010161 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010162 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010163 Owned(Args[1]));
10164 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10165 return ExprError();
10166
10167 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10168
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010169 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010170 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10171 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10172 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010173
10174 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010175 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10176 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010177 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
10178 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010179 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10180 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010181 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10182 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010183
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010184 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10185 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010186 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010187 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010188
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010189 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010190 FnDecl))
10191 return ExprError();
10192
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010193 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010194 } else {
10195 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10196 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10197 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010198 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10199 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10200 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10201 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010202 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010203 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10204
10205 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10206 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10207 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10208 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10209 return ExprError();
10210 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010211
10212 break;
10213 }
10214 }
10215
10216 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010217 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10218 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10219 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10220 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10221 else
10222 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10223 << Args[0]->getType()
10224 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010225 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010226 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010227 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010228 }
10229
10230 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010231 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010232 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010233 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10234 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010235 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010236 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010237 return ExprError();
10238
10239 case OR_Deleted:
10240 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10241 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010242 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010243 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010244 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010245 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010246 return ExprError();
10247 }
10248
10249 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010250 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010251}
10252
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010253/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10254/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10255/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10256/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10257/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010258/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10259/// member function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010260ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010261Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
10262 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010263 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010264 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10265 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10266
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010267 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10268 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010269 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010270
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010271 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10272 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10273 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10274 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10275
10276 QualType fnType =
10277 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10278
10279 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10280 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10281 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10282
10283 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10284 // member function we're calling.
10285 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10286
10287 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10288 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10289 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10290 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10291
10292 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10293 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10294 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10295 if (difference) {
10296 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10297 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10298 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10299 << qualsString
10300 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10301 }
10302
10303 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
10304 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
10305 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10306
10307 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
10308 op->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
10309 call, 0))
10310 return ExprError();
10311
10312 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
10313 return ExprError();
10314
10315 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10316 }
10317
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010318 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10319 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10320 return ExprError();
10321
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010322 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010323 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010324 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010325 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010326 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10327 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010328 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010329 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010330 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010331 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010332 } else {
10333 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010334 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010335
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010336 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010337 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10338 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10339 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010340
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010341 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010342 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010343
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010344 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10345 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10346 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10347 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10348 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10349 }
10350
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010351 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10352 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10353
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010354 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10355 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10356 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10357 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10358
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010359
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010360 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +000010361 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010362 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
10363 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet);
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010364 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010365 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10366 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010367 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010368 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010369
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010370 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010371 ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010372 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010373 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010374 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010375 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010376 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010377 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010378 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10379 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010380 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010381 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010382 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010383
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010384 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10385
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010386 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10387
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010388 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010389 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010390 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010391 case OR_Success:
10392 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010393 MarkFunctionReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010394 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010395 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010396 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010397 break;
10398
10399 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010400 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010401 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010402 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010403 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10404 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010405 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010406 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010407
10408 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010409 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010410 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010411 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10412 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010413 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010414 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010415
10416 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010417 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010418 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010419 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010420 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010421 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010422 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10423 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010424 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010425 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010426 }
10427
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010428 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010429
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010430 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
10431 // non-member call based on that function.
10432 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10433 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
10434 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
10435 }
10436
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010437 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010438 }
10439
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010440 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
10441 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
10442 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10443
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010444 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010445 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010446 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010447 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010448
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +000010449 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010450 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010451 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010452 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010453
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010454 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010455 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
10456 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010457 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10458 ExprResult ObjectArg =
10459 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
10460 FoundDecl, Method);
10461 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
10462 return ExprError();
10463 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
10464 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010465
10466 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010467 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10468 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010469 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010470 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010471 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010472
Eli Friedmanff4b4072012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010473 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10474
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010475 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010476 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +000010477
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010478 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
10479 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
10480 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
10481 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
10482
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010483 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010484 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
10485 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
10486 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
10487 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
10488
10489 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010490 }
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010491 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010492 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010493}
10494
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010495/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10496/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10497/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10498/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010499ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010500Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +000010501 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010502 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010503 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010504 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
10505 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010506 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010507
10508 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10509 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10510 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010511
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010512 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
10513 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010514
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010515 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
10516 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +000010517 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010518 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
10519 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
10520 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
10521 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010522 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000010523 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010524
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010525 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +000010526 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010527 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010528 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010529
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010530 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10531 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
10532 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10533
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010534 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010535 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010536 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
10537 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +000010538 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010539 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010540
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010541 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010542 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
10543 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010544 //
10545 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
10546 //
10547 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
10548 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +000010549 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
10550 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
10551 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
10552 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010553 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
10554 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
10555 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
10556 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
10557 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +000010558 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +000010559 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +000010560 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010561 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010562 NamedDecl *D = *I;
10563 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
10564 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
10565 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010566
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010567 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
10568 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010569 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010570 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +000010571
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010572 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010573 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
10574 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
10575 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
10576 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
10577 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
10578 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010579
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010580 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10581 {
10582 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010583 Object.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10584 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010585 }
10586 }
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010587 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010588
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010589 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10590
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010591 // Perform overload resolution.
10592 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010593 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010594 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010595 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010596 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
10597 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010598 break;
10599
10600 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010601 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010602 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10603 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
10604 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010605 else
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010606 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010607 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010608 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010609 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10610 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010611 break;
10612
10613 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010614 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010615 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010616 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010617 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
10618 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010619 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010620
10621 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010622 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010623 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
10624 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010625 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010626 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010627 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010628 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10629 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010630 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010631 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010632
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010633 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010634 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010635
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010636 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10637
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010638 if (Best->Function == 0) {
10639 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
10640 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010641 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010642 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
10643 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
10644
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010645 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010646 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +000010647
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010648 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
10649 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
10650 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010651
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +000010652 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +000010653 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010654 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
10655 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +000010656 if (Call.isInvalid())
10657 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +000010658 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
10659 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
10660 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
10661 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010662
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +000010663 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010664 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010665 }
10666
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010667 MarkFunctionReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010668 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010669 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +000010670
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010671 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
10672 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
10673 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
10674 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010675 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10676 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010677
10678 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
10679 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
10680
10681 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
10682 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
10683 // list).
10684 Expr **MethodArgs;
10685 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
10686 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
10687 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
10688 } else {
10689 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
10690 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010691 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010692 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
10693 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010694
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010695 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
10696 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
10697 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010698 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010699 HadMultipleCandidates,
10700 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10701 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010702 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
10703 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010704
10705 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
10706 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010707 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
10708 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10709 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10710
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010711 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010712 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010713 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010714 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010715 delete [] MethodArgs;
10716
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010717 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +000010718 Method))
10719 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010720
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010721 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
10722 // slots in the call for them.
10723 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +000010724 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010725 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
10726 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
10727
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010728 bool IsError = false;
10729
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010730 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010731 ExprResult ObjRes =
10732 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
10733 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10734 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
10735 IsError = true;
10736 else
10737 Object = move(ObjRes);
10738 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010739
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010740 // Check the argument types.
10741 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010742 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010743 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010744 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010745
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010746 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010747
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010748 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010749 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010750 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010751 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010752 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010753
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010754 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
10755 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010756 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010757 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000010758 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
10759 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
10760 IsError = true;
10761 break;
10762 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010763
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000010764 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010765 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010766
10767 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
10768 }
10769
10770 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
10771 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
10772 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
10773 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010774 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
10775 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
10776 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010777 }
10778 }
10779
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010780 if (IsError) return true;
10781
Eli Friedmanff4b4072012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010782 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10783
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010784 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +000010785 return true;
10786
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +000010787 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010788}
10789
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010790/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010791/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010792/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010793ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010794Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010795 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
10796 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010797
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010798 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
10799 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010800
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010801 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
10802
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010803 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
10804 //
10805 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
10806 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
10807 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
10808 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010809 DeclarationName OpName =
10810 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010811 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +000010812 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010813
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010814 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +000010815 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
10816 << Base->getSourceRange()))
10817 return ExprError();
10818
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010819 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10820 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
10821 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +000010822
10823 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010824 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010825 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
10826 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010827 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010828
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010829 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10830
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010831 // Perform overload resolution.
10832 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010833 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010834 case OR_Success:
10835 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
10836 break;
10837
10838 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
10839 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10840 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010841 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010842 else
10843 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010844 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010845 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010846 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010847
10848 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010849 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10850 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010851 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010852 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010853
10854 case OR_Deleted:
10855 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10856 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010857 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010858 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010859 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010860 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010861 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010862 }
10863
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010864 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010865 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010866 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010867
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010868 // Convert the object parameter.
10869 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010870 ExprResult BaseResult =
10871 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10872 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10873 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010874 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010875 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +000010876
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010877 // Build the operator call.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010878 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010879 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010880 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10881 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010882
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010883 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
10884 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10885 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010886 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010887 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010888 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010889
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010890 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010891 Method))
10892 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +000010893
10894 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010895}
10896
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010897/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
10898/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
10899/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
10900/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +000010901/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +000010902Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010903 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010904 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010905 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
10906 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010907 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010908 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010909
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010910 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010911 }
10912
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010913 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010914 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
10915 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010916 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010917 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +000010918 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000010919 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010920 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010921 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010922
10923 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000010924 ICE->getCastKind(),
10925 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000010926 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010927 }
10928
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010929 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010930 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010931 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000010932 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10933 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10934 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
10935 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010936 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010937 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
10938 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
10939 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010940 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
10941 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010942 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010943 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010944
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010945 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
10946 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
10947 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
10948 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
10949
10950 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
10951 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
10952 // appropriate pointer to member type.
10953 QualType ClassType
10954 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
10955 QualType MemPtrType
10956 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
10957
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010958 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
10959 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
10960 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000010961 }
10962 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010963 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
10964 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010965 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010966 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010967
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010968 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010969 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010970 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010971 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010972 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010973
10974 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010975 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10976 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010977 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010978 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10979 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010980 }
10981
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010982 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
10983 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010984 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010985 Fn,
10986 ULE->getNameLoc(),
10987 Fn->getType(),
10988 VK_LValue,
10989 Found.getDecl(),
10990 TemplateArgs);
10991 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
10992 return DRE;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010993 }
10994
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010995 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010996 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010997 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10998 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10999 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11000 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11001 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011002
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011003 Expr *Base;
11004
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011005 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
11006 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011007 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
11008 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011009 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11010 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011011 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011012 Fn,
11013 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11014 Fn->getType(),
11015 VK_LValue,
11016 Found.getDecl(),
11017 TemplateArgs);
11018 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
11019 return DRE;
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011020 } else {
11021 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
11022 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011023 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman73a04092012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011024 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011025 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11026 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11027 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11028 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011029 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011030 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011031
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011032 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11033 QualType type;
11034 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11035 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11036 type = Fn->getType();
11037 } else {
11038 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11039 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11040 }
11041
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011042 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11043 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11044 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011045 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011046 Fn,
11047 Found,
11048 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
11049 TemplateArgs,
11050 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
11051 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
11052 return ME;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011053 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011054
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011055 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011056}
11057
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011058ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011059 DeclAccessPair Found,
11060 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011061 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +000011062}
11063
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000011064} // end namespace clang